PostgreSQL Source Code git master
Loading...
Searching...
No Matches
xlog.c
Go to the documentation of this file.
1/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------
2 *
3 * xlog.c
4 * PostgreSQL write-ahead log manager
5 *
6 * The Write-Ahead Log (WAL) functionality is split into several source
7 * files, in addition to this one:
8 *
9 * xloginsert.c - Functions for constructing WAL records
10 * xlogrecovery.c - WAL recovery and standby code
11 * xlogreader.c - Facility for reading WAL files and parsing WAL records
12 * xlogutils.c - Helper functions for WAL redo routines
13 *
14 * This file contains functions for coordinating database startup and
15 * checkpointing, and managing the write-ahead log buffers when the
16 * system is running.
17 *
18 * StartupXLOG() is the main entry point of the startup process. It
19 * coordinates database startup, performing WAL recovery, and the
20 * transition from WAL recovery into normal operations.
21 *
22 * XLogInsertRecord() inserts a WAL record into the WAL buffers. Most
23 * callers should not call this directly, but use the functions in
24 * xloginsert.c to construct the WAL record. XLogFlush() can be used
25 * to force the WAL to disk.
26 *
27 * In addition to those, there are many other functions for interrogating
28 * the current system state, and for starting/stopping backups.
29 *
30 *
31 * Portions Copyright (c) 1996-2026, PostgreSQL Global Development Group
32 * Portions Copyright (c) 1994, Regents of the University of California
33 *
34 * src/backend/access/transam/xlog.c
35 *
36 *-------------------------------------------------------------------------
37 */
38
39#include "postgres.h"
40
41#include <ctype.h>
42#include <math.h>
43#include <time.h>
44#include <fcntl.h>
45#include <sys/stat.h>
46#include <sys/time.h>
47#include <unistd.h>
48
49#include "access/clog.h"
50#include "access/commit_ts.h"
51#include "access/heaptoast.h"
52#include "access/multixact.h"
53#include "access/rewriteheap.h"
54#include "access/subtrans.h"
55#include "access/timeline.h"
56#include "access/transam.h"
57#include "access/twophase.h"
58#include "access/xact.h"
60#include "access/xlogarchive.h"
61#include "access/xloginsert.h"
62#include "access/xlogreader.h"
63#include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
64#include "access/xlogutils.h"
65#include "access/xlogwait.h"
66#include "backup/basebackup.h"
67#include "catalog/catversion.h"
68#include "catalog/pg_control.h"
69#include "catalog/pg_database.h"
71#include "common/file_utils.h"
72#include "executor/instrument.h"
73#include "miscadmin.h"
74#include "pg_trace.h"
75#include "pgstat.h"
76#include "port/atomics.h"
77#include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
78#include "postmaster/startup.h"
81#include "replication/origin.h"
82#include "replication/slot.h"
87#include "storage/bufmgr.h"
88#include "storage/fd.h"
89#include "storage/ipc.h"
91#include "storage/latch.h"
92#include "storage/predicate.h"
93#include "storage/proc.h"
94#include "storage/procarray.h"
95#include "storage/reinit.h"
96#include "storage/spin.h"
97#include "storage/sync.h"
98#include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
99#include "utils/guc_tables.h"
102#include "utils/ps_status.h"
103#include "utils/relmapper.h"
104#include "utils/snapmgr.h"
105#include "utils/timeout.h"
106#include "utils/timestamp.h"
107#include "utils/varlena.h"
108
109#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
110#include "utils/memutils.h"
111#endif
112
113/* timeline ID to be used when bootstrapping */
114#define BootstrapTimeLineID 1
115
116/* User-settable parameters */
117int max_wal_size_mb = 1024; /* 1 GB */
118int min_wal_size_mb = 80; /* 80 MB */
120int XLOGbuffers = -1;
124bool EnableHotStandby = false;
125bool fullPageWrites = true;
126bool wal_log_hints = false;
130bool wal_init_zero = true;
131bool wal_recycle = true;
132bool log_checkpoints = true;
135int CommitDelay = 0; /* precommit delay in microseconds */
136int CommitSiblings = 5; /* # concurrent xacts needed to sleep */
139int wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024;
141
142#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
143bool XLOG_DEBUG = false;
144#endif
145
147
148/*
149 * Number of WAL insertion locks to use. A higher value allows more insertions
150 * to happen concurrently, but adds some CPU overhead to flushing the WAL,
151 * which needs to iterate all the locks.
152 */
153#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS 8
154
155/*
156 * Max distance from last checkpoint, before triggering a new xlog-based
157 * checkpoint.
158 */
160
161/* Estimated distance between checkpoints, in bytes */
163static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0;
164
165/*
166 * Track whether there were any deferred checks for custom resource managers
167 * specified in wal_consistency_checking.
168 */
170
171/*
172 * GUC support
173 */
175 {"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
176#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
177 {"fsync_writethrough", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, false},
178#endif
179 {"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
180#ifdef O_SYNC
181 {"open_sync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, false},
182#endif
183#ifdef O_DSYNC
184 {"open_datasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, false},
185#endif
186 {NULL, 0, false}
187};
188
189
190/*
191 * Although only "on", "off", and "always" are documented,
192 * we accept all the likely variants of "on" and "off".
193 */
195 {"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
196 {"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
197 {"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
198 {"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
199 {"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
200 {"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
201 {"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
202 {"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
203 {"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
204 {NULL, 0, false}
205};
206
207/*
208 * Statistics for current checkpoint are collected in this global struct.
209 * Because only the checkpointer or a stand-alone backend can perform
210 * checkpoints, this will be unused in normal backends.
211 */
213
214/*
215 * During recovery, lastFullPageWrites keeps track of full_page_writes that
216 * the replayed WAL records indicate. It's initialized with full_page_writes
217 * that the recovery starting checkpoint record indicates, and then updated
218 * each time XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record is replayed.
219 */
221
222/*
223 * Local copy of the state tracked by SharedRecoveryState in shared memory,
224 * It is false if SharedRecoveryState is RECOVERY_STATE_DONE. True actually
225 * means "not known, need to check the shared state".
226 */
227static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true;
228
229/*
230 * Local state for XLogInsertAllowed():
231 * 1: unconditionally allowed to insert XLOG
232 * 0: unconditionally not allowed to insert XLOG
233 * -1: must check RecoveryInProgress(); disallow until it is false
234 * Most processes start with -1 and transition to 1 after seeing that recovery
235 * is not in progress. But we can also force the value for special cases.
236 * The coding in XLogInsertAllowed() depends on the first two of these states
237 * being numerically the same as bool true and false.
238 */
240
241/*
242 * ProcLastRecPtr points to the start of the last XLOG record inserted by the
243 * current backend. It is updated for all inserts. XactLastRecEnd points to
244 * end+1 of the last record, and is reset when we end a top-level transaction,
245 * or start a new one; so it can be used to tell if the current transaction has
246 * created any XLOG records.
247 *
248 * While in parallel mode, this may not be fully up to date. When committing,
249 * a transaction can assume this covers all xlog records written either by the
250 * user backend or by any parallel worker which was present at any point during
251 * the transaction. But when aborting, or when still in parallel mode, other
252 * parallel backends may have written WAL records at later LSNs than the value
253 * stored here. The parallel leader advances its own copy, when necessary,
254 * in WaitForParallelWorkersToFinish.
255 */
259
260/*
261 * RedoRecPtr is this backend's local copy of the REDO record pointer
262 * (which is almost but not quite the same as a pointer to the most recent
263 * CHECKPOINT record). We update this from the shared-memory copy,
264 * XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr, whenever we can safely do so (ie, when we
265 * hold an insertion lock). See XLogInsertRecord for details. We are also
266 * allowed to update from XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr if we hold the info_lck;
267 * see GetRedoRecPtr.
268 *
269 * NB: Code that uses this variable must be prepared not only for the
270 * possibility that it may be arbitrarily out of date, but also for the
271 * possibility that it might be set to InvalidXLogRecPtr. We used to
272 * initialize it as a side effect of the first call to RecoveryInProgress(),
273 * which meant that most code that might use it could assume that it had a
274 * real if perhaps stale value. That's no longer the case.
275 */
277
278/*
279 * doPageWrites is this backend's local copy of (fullPageWrites ||
280 * runningBackups > 0). It is used together with RedoRecPtr to decide whether
281 * a full-page image of a page need to be taken.
282 *
283 * NB: Initially this is false, and there's no guarantee that it will be
284 * initialized to any other value before it is first used. Any code that
285 * makes use of it must recheck the value after obtaining a WALInsertLock,
286 * and respond appropriately if it turns out that the previous value wasn't
287 * accurate.
288 */
289static bool doPageWrites;
290
291/*----------
292 * Shared-memory data structures for XLOG control
293 *
294 * LogwrtRqst indicates a byte position that we need to write and/or fsync
295 * the log up to (all records before that point must be written or fsynced).
296 * The positions already written/fsynced are maintained in logWriteResult
297 * and logFlushResult using atomic access.
298 * In addition to the shared variable, each backend has a private copy of
299 * both in LogwrtResult, which is updated when convenient.
300 *
301 * The request bookkeeping is simpler: there is a shared XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst
302 * (protected by info_lck), but we don't need to cache any copies of it.
303 *
304 * info_lck is only held long enough to read/update the protected variables,
305 * so it's a plain spinlock. The other locks are held longer (potentially
306 * over I/O operations), so we use LWLocks for them. These locks are:
307 *
308 * WALBufMappingLock: must be held to replace a page in the WAL buffer cache.
309 * It is only held while initializing and changing the mapping. If the
310 * contents of the buffer being replaced haven't been written yet, the mapping
311 * lock is released while the write is done, and reacquired afterwards.
312 *
313 * WALWriteLock: must be held to write WAL buffers to disk (XLogWrite or
314 * XLogFlush).
315 *
316 * ControlFileLock: must be held to read/update control file or create
317 * new log file.
318 *
319 *----------
320 */
321
322typedef struct XLogwrtRqst
323{
324 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 to write out */
325 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 to flush */
327
328typedef struct XLogwrtResult
329{
330 XLogRecPtr Write; /* last byte + 1 written out */
331 XLogRecPtr Flush; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
333
334/*
335 * Inserting to WAL is protected by a small fixed number of WAL insertion
336 * locks. To insert to the WAL, you must hold one of the locks - it doesn't
337 * matter which one. To lock out other concurrent insertions, you must hold
338 * of them. Each WAL insertion lock consists of a lightweight lock, plus an
339 * indicator of how far the insertion has progressed (insertingAt).
340 *
341 * The insertingAt values are read when a process wants to flush WAL from
342 * the in-memory buffers to disk, to check that all the insertions to the
343 * region the process is about to write out have finished. You could simply
344 * wait for all currently in-progress insertions to finish, but the
345 * insertingAt indicator allows you to ignore insertions to later in the WAL,
346 * so that you only wait for the insertions that are modifying the buffers
347 * you're about to write out.
348 *
349 * This isn't just an optimization. If all the WAL buffers are dirty, an
350 * inserter that's holding a WAL insert lock might need to evict an old WAL
351 * buffer, which requires flushing the WAL. If it's possible for an inserter
352 * to block on another inserter unnecessarily, deadlock can arise when two
353 * inserters holding a WAL insert lock wait for each other to finish their
354 * insertion.
355 *
356 * Small WAL records that don't cross a page boundary never update the value,
357 * the WAL record is just copied to the page and the lock is released. But
358 * to avoid the deadlock-scenario explained above, the indicator is always
359 * updated before sleeping while holding an insertion lock.
360 *
361 * lastImportantAt contains the LSN of the last important WAL record inserted
362 * using a given lock. This value is used to detect if there has been
363 * important WAL activity since the last time some action, like a checkpoint,
364 * was performed - allowing to not repeat the action if not. The LSN is
365 * updated for all insertions, unless the XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT flag was
366 * set. lastImportantAt is never cleared, only overwritten by the LSN of newer
367 * records. Tracking the WAL activity directly in WALInsertLock has the
368 * advantage of not needing any additional locks to update the value.
369 */
376
377/*
378 * All the WAL insertion locks are allocated as an array in shared memory. We
379 * force the array stride to be a power of 2, which saves a few cycles in
380 * indexing, but more importantly also ensures that individual slots don't
381 * cross cache line boundaries. (Of course, we have to also ensure that the
382 * array start address is suitably aligned.)
383 */
389
390/*
391 * Session status of running backup, used for sanity checks in SQL-callable
392 * functions to start and stop backups.
393 */
395
396/*
397 * Shared state data for WAL insertion.
398 */
399typedef struct XLogCtlInsert
400{
401 slock_t insertpos_lck; /* protects CurrBytePos and PrevBytePos */
402
403 /*
404 * CurrBytePos is the end of reserved WAL. The next record will be
405 * inserted at that position. PrevBytePos is the start position of the
406 * previously inserted (or rather, reserved) record - it is copied to the
407 * prev-link of the next record. These are stored as "usable byte
408 * positions" rather than XLogRecPtrs (see XLogBytePosToRecPtr()).
409 */
412
413 /*
414 * Make sure the above heavily-contended spinlock and byte positions are
415 * on their own cache line. In particular, the RedoRecPtr and full page
416 * write variables below should be on a different cache line. They are
417 * read on every WAL insertion, but updated rarely, and we don't want
418 * those reads to steal the cache line containing Curr/PrevBytePos.
419 */
421
422 /*
423 * fullPageWrites is the authoritative value used by all backends to
424 * determine whether to write full-page image to WAL. This shared value,
425 * instead of the process-local fullPageWrites, is required because, when
426 * full_page_writes is changed by SIGHUP, we must WAL-log it before it
427 * actually affects WAL-logging by backends. Checkpointer sets at startup
428 * or after SIGHUP.
429 *
430 * To read these fields, you must hold an insertion lock. To modify them,
431 * you must hold ALL the locks.
432 */
433 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* current redo point for insertions */
435
436 /*
437 * runningBackups is a counter indicating the number of backups currently
438 * in progress. lastBackupStart is the latest checkpoint redo location
439 * used as a starting point for an online backup.
440 */
443
444 /*
445 * WAL insertion locks.
446 */
449
450/*
451 * Total shared-memory state for XLOG.
452 */
453typedef struct XLogCtlData
454{
456
457 /* Protected by info_lck: */
459 XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr; /* a recent copy of Insert->RedoRecPtr */
460 XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN; /* LSN of newest async commit/abort */
461 XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN; /* oldest LSN needed by any slot */
462
463 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo; /* latest removed/recycled XLOG segment */
464
465 /* Fake LSN counter, for unlogged relations. */
467
468 /* Time and LSN of last xlog segment switch. Protected by WALWriteLock. */
471
472 /* These are accessed using atomics -- info_lck not needed */
473 pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult; /* last byte + 1 inserted to buffers */
474 pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult; /* last byte + 1 written out */
475 pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult; /* last byte + 1 flushed */
476
477 /*
478 * Latest initialized page in the cache (last byte position + 1).
479 *
480 * To change the identity of a buffer (and InitializedUpTo), you need to
481 * hold WALBufMappingLock. To change the identity of a buffer that's
482 * still dirty, the old page needs to be written out first, and for that
483 * you need WALWriteLock, and you need to ensure that there are no
484 * in-progress insertions to the page by calling
485 * WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().
486 */
488
489 /*
490 * These values do not change after startup, although the pointed-to pages
491 * and xlblocks values certainly do. xlblocks values are protected by
492 * WALBufMappingLock.
493 */
494 char *pages; /* buffers for unwritten XLOG pages */
495 pg_atomic_uint64 *xlblocks; /* 1st byte ptr-s + XLOG_BLCKSZ */
496 int XLogCacheBlck; /* highest allocated xlog buffer index */
497
498 /*
499 * InsertTimeLineID is the timeline into which new WAL is being inserted
500 * and flushed. It is zero during recovery, and does not change once set.
501 *
502 * If we create a new timeline when the system was started up,
503 * PrevTimeLineID is the old timeline's ID that we forked off from.
504 * Otherwise it's equal to InsertTimeLineID.
505 *
506 * We set these fields while holding info_lck. Most that reads these
507 * values knows that recovery is no longer in progress and so can safely
508 * read the value without a lock, but code that could be run either during
509 * or after recovery can take info_lck while reading these values.
510 */
513
514 /*
515 * SharedRecoveryState indicates if we're still in crash or archive
516 * recovery. Protected by info_lck.
517 */
519
520 /*
521 * InstallXLogFileSegmentActive indicates whether the checkpointer should
522 * arrange for future segments by recycling and/or PreallocXlogFiles().
523 * Protected by ControlFileLock. Only the startup process changes it. If
524 * true, anyone can use InstallXLogFileSegment(). If false, the startup
525 * process owns the exclusive right to install segments, by reading from
526 * the archive and possibly replacing existing files.
527 */
529
530 /*
531 * WalWriterSleeping indicates whether the WAL writer is currently in
532 * low-power mode (and hence should be nudged if an async commit occurs).
533 * Protected by info_lck.
534 */
536
537 /*
538 * During recovery, we keep a copy of the latest checkpoint record here.
539 * lastCheckPointRecPtr points to start of checkpoint record and
540 * lastCheckPointEndPtr points to end+1 of checkpoint record. Used by the
541 * checkpointer when it wants to create a restartpoint.
542 *
543 * Protected by info_lck.
544 */
548
549 /*
550 * lastFpwDisableRecPtr points to the start of the last replayed
551 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record that instructs full_page_writes is disabled.
552 */
554
555 slock_t info_lck; /* locks shared variables shown above */
557
558/*
559 * Classification of XLogInsertRecord operations.
560 */
567
569
570/* a private copy of XLogCtl->Insert.WALInsertLocks, for convenience */
572
573/*
574 * We maintain an image of pg_control in shared memory.
575 */
577
578/*
579 * Calculate the amount of space left on the page after 'endptr'. Beware
580 * multiple evaluation!
581 */
582#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr) \
583 (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
584
585/* Macro to advance to next buffer index. */
586#define NextBufIdx(idx) \
587 (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
588
589/*
590 * XLogRecPtrToBufIdx returns the index of the WAL buffer that holds, or
591 * would hold if it was in cache, the page containing 'recptr'.
592 */
593#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr) \
594 (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
595
596/*
597 * These are the number of bytes in a WAL page usable for WAL data.
598 */
599#define UsableBytesInPage (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
600
601/*
602 * Convert values of GUCs measured in megabytes to equiv. segment count.
603 * Rounds down.
604 */
605#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize) XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
606
607/* The number of bytes in a WAL segment usable for WAL data. */
609
610/*
611 * Private, possibly out-of-date copy of shared LogwrtResult.
612 * See discussion above.
613 */
615
616/*
617 * Update local copy of shared XLogCtl->log{Write,Flush}Result
618 *
619 * It's critical that Flush always trails Write, so the order of the reads is
620 * important, as is the barrier. See also XLogWrite.
621 */
622#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target) \
623 do { \
624 _target.Flush = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logFlushResult); \
625 pg_read_barrier(); \
626 _target.Write = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->logWriteResult); \
627 } while (0)
628
629/*
630 * openLogFile is -1 or a kernel FD for an open log file segment.
631 * openLogSegNo identifies the segment, and openLogTLI the corresponding TLI.
632 * These variables are only used to write the XLOG, and so will normally refer
633 * to the active segment.
634 *
635 * Note: call Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD to track consumption of this FD.
636 */
637static int openLogFile = -1;
640
641/*
642 * Local copies of equivalent fields in the control file. When running
643 * crash recovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint is set to InvalidXLogRecPtr as we
644 * expect to replay all the WAL available, and updateMinRecoveryPoint is
645 * switched to false to prevent any updates while replaying records.
646 * Those values are kept consistent as long as crash recovery runs.
647 */
650static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true;
651
652/* For WALInsertLockAcquire/Release functions */
653static int MyLockNo = 0;
654static bool holdingAllLocks = false;
655
656#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
658#endif
659
663static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void);
664static void XLogReportParameters(void);
665static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void);
666static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void);
670static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags);
672
674 bool opportunistic);
675static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible);
676static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath,
678 TimeLineID tli);
679static void XLogFileClose(void);
680static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli);
681static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void);
684static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de,
687static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename);
688static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void);
689static void CleanupBackupHistory(void);
690static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force);
691static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void);
692static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version);
693static void WriteControlFile(void);
694static void ReadControlFile(void);
695static void UpdateControlFile(void);
696static char *str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize);
697
698static int get_sync_bit(int method);
699
700static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch,
703 TimeLineID tli);
704static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos,
709static char *GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli);
713
714static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void);
715static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void);
716static void WALInsertLockRelease(void);
717static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt);
718
719/*
720 * Insert an XLOG record represented by an already-constructed chain of data
721 * chunks. This is a low-level routine; to construct the WAL record header
722 * and data, use the higher-level routines in xloginsert.c.
723 *
724 * If 'fpw_lsn' is valid, it is the oldest LSN among the pages that this
725 * WAL record applies to, that were not included in the record as full page
726 * images. If fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr, the function does not perform the
727 * insertion and returns InvalidXLogRecPtr. The caller can then recalculate
728 * which pages need a full-page image, and retry. If fpw_lsn is invalid, the
729 * record is always inserted.
730 *
731 * 'flags' gives more in-depth control on the record being inserted. See
732 * XLogSetRecordFlags() for details.
733 *
734 * 'topxid_included' tells whether the top-transaction id is logged along with
735 * current subtransaction. See XLogRecordAssemble().
736 *
737 * The first XLogRecData in the chain must be for the record header, and its
738 * data must be MAXALIGNed. XLogInsertRecord fills in the xl_prev and
739 * xl_crc fields in the header, the rest of the header must already be filled
740 * by the caller.
741 *
742 * Returns XLOG pointer to end of record (beginning of next record).
743 * This can be used as LSN for data pages affected by the logged action.
744 * (LSN is the XLOG point up to which the XLOG must be flushed to disk
745 * before the data page can be written out. This implements the basic
746 * WAL rule "write the log before the data".)
747 */
751 uint8 flags,
752 int num_fpi,
754 bool topxid_included)
755{
758 bool inserted;
759 XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
760 uint8 info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
766
767 /* Does this record type require special handling? */
768 if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
769 {
770 if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
772 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
774 }
775
776 /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
778
779 /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
780 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
781 elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
782
783 /*
784 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
785 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
786 */
788
789 /*----------
790 *
791 * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
792 * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
793 * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
794 *
795 * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
796 * reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
797 * insertpos_lck.
798 *
799 * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
800 * correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
801 * record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
802 *
803 * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
804 * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
805 * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
806 * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
807 * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
808 * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
809 * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
810 *
811 * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
812 * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
813 *
814 * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
815 * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
816 * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
817 * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
818 *
819 *----------
820 */
822
823 if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
824 {
826
827 /*
828 * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
829 * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
830 * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
831 * this case and fast otherwise.
832 *
833 * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
834 * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
835 * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
836 *
837 * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
838 * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
839 * our local copy but not force a recomputation. (If doPageWrites was
840 * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
841 * but we choose not to bother.)
842 */
843 if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
844 {
846 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
847 }
848 doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
849
850 if (doPageWrites &&
853 {
854 /*
855 * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
856 * didn't back up. Start over.
857 */
860 return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
861 }
862
863 /*
864 * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
865 * pointer.
866 */
868 &rechdr->xl_prev);
869
870 /* Normal records are always inserted. */
871 inserted = true;
872 }
873 else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
874 {
875 /*
876 * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
877 * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
878 * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
879 * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
880 *
881 * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
882 * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
883 * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
884 * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
885 */
889 }
890 else
891 {
893
894 /*
895 * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
896 * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
897 * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
898 * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
899 * update it afterwards.
900 */
904 &rechdr->xl_prev);
905 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
906 inserted = true;
907 }
908
909 if (inserted)
910 {
911 /*
912 * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
913 * header.
914 */
915 rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
918 rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
919
920 /*
921 * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
922 * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
923 */
924 CopyXLogRecordToWAL(rechdr->xl_tot_len,
927
928 /*
929 * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
930 * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
931 * update the first one.
932 */
933 if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
934 {
935 int lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
936
938 }
939 }
940 else
941 {
942 /*
943 * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
944 * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
945 * to do anything.
946 */
947 }
948
949 /*
950 * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
951 */
953
955
957
958 /*
959 * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
960 * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
961 */
962 if (topxid_included)
964
965 /*
966 * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
967 */
969 {
971 /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
976 }
977
978 /*
979 * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
980 * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
981 * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
982 */
983 if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
984 {
987
988 /*
989 * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
990 * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
991 * xlog-switch record.
992 */
993 if (inserted)
994 {
997 {
999
1000 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
1002 else
1004 }
1005 }
1006 }
1007
1008#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
1009 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
1010 {
1012 XLogRecord *record;
1016 char *errormsg = NULL;
1018
1020
1022 appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%08X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
1023
1024 /*
1025 * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
1026 * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
1027 * contiguous chunk.
1028 */
1030 for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
1032
1033 /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
1034 record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
1037
1038 if (!debug_reader)
1040 XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
1041 .segment_open = NULL,
1042 .segment_close = NULL),
1043 NULL);
1044 if (!debug_reader)
1045 {
1046 appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
1047 }
1049 decoded,
1050 record,
1051 EndPos,
1052 &errormsg))
1053 {
1054 appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
1055 errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
1056 }
1057 else
1058 {
1059 appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
1060
1061 debug_reader->record = decoded;
1063 debug_reader->record = NULL;
1064 }
1065 elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
1066
1067 pfree(decoded);
1068 pfree(buf.data);
1069 pfree(recordBuf.data);
1071 }
1072#endif
1073
1074 /*
1075 * Update our global variables
1076 */
1079
1080 /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
1081 if (inserted)
1082 {
1083 pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
1087
1088 /* Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data */
1089 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
1090 }
1091
1092 return EndPos;
1093}
1094
1095/*
1096 * Reserves the right amount of space for a record of given size from the WAL.
1097 * *StartPos is set to the beginning of the reserved section, *EndPos to
1098 * its end+1. *PrevPtr is set to the beginning of the previous record; it is
1099 * used to set the xl_prev of this record.
1100 *
1101 * This is the performance critical part of XLogInsert that must be serialized
1102 * across backends. The rest can happen mostly in parallel. Try to keep this
1103 * section as short as possible, insertpos_lck can be heavily contended on a
1104 * busy system.
1105 *
1106 * NB: The space calculation here must match the code in CopyXLogRecordToWAL,
1107 * where we actually copy the record to the reserved space.
1108 *
1109 * NB: Testing shows that XLogInsertRecord runs faster if this code is inlined;
1110 * however, because there are two call sites, the compiler is reluctant to
1111 * inline. We use pg_attribute_always_inline here to try to convince it.
1112 */
1116{
1121
1122 size = MAXALIGN(size);
1123
1124 /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
1125 Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
1126
1127 /*
1128 * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
1129 * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
1130 * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
1131 * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
1132 * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
1133 * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
1134 * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
1135 * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
1136 */
1137 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1138
1139 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1140 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1141 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1142 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1143 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1144
1145 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1146
1150
1151 /*
1152 * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
1153 * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
1154 */
1158}
1159
1160/*
1161 * Like ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), but for an xlog-switch record.
1162 *
1163 * A log-switch record is handled slightly differently. The rest of the
1164 * segment will be reserved for this insertion, as indicated by the returned
1165 * *EndPos value. However, if we are already at the beginning of the current
1166 * segment, *StartPos and *EndPos are set to the current location without
1167 * reserving any space, and the function returns false.
1168*/
1169static bool
1171{
1177 XLogRecPtr ptr;
1179
1180 /*
1181 * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
1182 * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
1183 * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
1184 * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
1185 */
1186 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1187
1188 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1189
1191 if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
1192 {
1193 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1194 *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
1195 return false;
1196 }
1197
1198 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1199 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1200
1203
1206 {
1207 /* consume the rest of the segment */
1208 *EndPos += segleft;
1210 }
1211 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1212 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1213
1214 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1215
1217
1222
1223 return true;
1224}
1225
1226/*
1227 * Subroutine of XLogInsertRecord. Copies a WAL record to an already-reserved
1228 * area in the WAL.
1229 */
1230static void
1233{
1234 char *currpos;
1235 int freespace;
1236 int written;
1239
1240 /*
1241 * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
1242 * inserting to.
1243 */
1244 CurrPos = StartPos;
1245 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1246 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1247
1248 /*
1249 * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
1250 * on this page.
1251 */
1252 Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
1253
1254 /* Copy record data */
1255 written = 0;
1256 while (rdata != NULL)
1257 {
1258 const char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
1259 int rdata_len = rdata->len;
1260
1261 while (rdata_len > freespace)
1262 {
1263 /*
1264 * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
1265 */
1266 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
1267 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
1268 rdata_data += freespace;
1269 rdata_len -= freespace;
1270 written += freespace;
1271 CurrPos += freespace;
1272
1273 /*
1274 * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
1275 * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
1276 *
1277 * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
1278 * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
1279 * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
1280 * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
1281 */
1282 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1283 pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
1284 pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
1285 pagehdr->xlp_info |= XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD;
1286
1287 /* skip over the page header */
1289 {
1291 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1292 }
1293 else
1294 {
1296 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1297 }
1298 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1299 }
1300
1301 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
1302 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
1303 currpos += rdata_len;
1304 CurrPos += rdata_len;
1305 freespace -= rdata_len;
1306 written += rdata_len;
1307
1308 rdata = rdata->next;
1309 }
1311
1312 /*
1313 * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
1314 * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment. We
1315 * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
1316 */
1318 {
1319 /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
1321
1322 /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
1324
1325 /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
1326 CurrPos += freespace;
1327
1328 /*
1329 * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
1330 * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
1331 * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
1332 * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
1333 */
1334 while (CurrPos < EndPos)
1335 {
1336 /*
1337 * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
1338 * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
1339 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...). The page would be left initialized
1340 * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
1341 * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
1342 *
1343 * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
1344 * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
1345 * differ from page to page) are not. The effect varies with
1346 * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
1347 * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
1348 *
1349 * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
1350 * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
1351 * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
1352 * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
1353 * and zero most of the page. Then we just zero the page header.
1354 */
1355 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1356 MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1357
1359 }
1360 }
1361 else
1362 {
1363 /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
1365 }
1366
1367 if (CurrPos != EndPos)
1368 ereport(PANIC,
1370 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
1371}
1372
1373/*
1374 * Acquire a WAL insertion lock, for inserting to WAL.
1375 */
1376static void
1378{
1379 bool immed;
1380
1381 /*
1382 * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
1383 * the one we used last time. If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
1384 * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
1385 * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
1386 * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
1387 *
1388 * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
1389 * (semi-)randomly. This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
1390 * lot of very short connections.
1391 */
1392 static int lockToTry = -1;
1393
1394 if (lockToTry == -1)
1397
1398 /*
1399 * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
1400 * insert location yet.
1401 */
1403 if (!immed)
1404 {
1405 /*
1406 * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
1407 * time. On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
1408 * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
1409 * lock that no-one else is using. On a system with more inserters
1410 * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
1411 * across the locks.
1412 */
1414 }
1415}
1416
1417/*
1418 * Acquire all WAL insertion locks, to prevent other backends from inserting
1419 * to WAL.
1420 */
1421static void
1423{
1424 int i;
1425
1426 /*
1427 * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
1428 * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
1429 * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
1430 */
1431 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
1432 {
1437 }
1438 /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
1440
1441 holdingAllLocks = true;
1442}
1443
1444/*
1445 * Release our insertion lock (or locks, if we're holding them all).
1446 *
1447 * NB: Reset all variables to 0, so they cause LWLockWaitForVar to block the
1448 * next time the lock is acquired.
1449 */
1450static void
1452{
1453 if (holdingAllLocks)
1454 {
1455 int i;
1456
1457 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1460 0);
1461
1462 holdingAllLocks = false;
1463 }
1464 else
1465 {
1468 0);
1469 }
1470}
1471
1472/*
1473 * Update our insertingAt value, to let others know that we've finished
1474 * inserting up to that point.
1475 */
1476static void
1478{
1479 if (holdingAllLocks)
1480 {
1481 /*
1482 * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
1483 * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
1484 */
1487 insertingAt);
1488 }
1489 else
1492 insertingAt);
1493}
1494
1495/*
1496 * Wait for any WAL insertions < upto to finish.
1497 *
1498 * Returns the location of the oldest insertion that is still in-progress.
1499 * Any WAL prior to that point has been fully copied into WAL buffers, and
1500 * can be flushed out to disk. Because this waits for any insertions older
1501 * than 'upto' to finish, the return value is always >= 'upto'.
1502 *
1503 * Note: When you are about to write out WAL, you must call this function
1504 * *before* acquiring WALWriteLock, to avoid deadlocks. This function might
1505 * need to wait for an insertion to finish (or at least advance to next
1506 * uninitialized page), and the inserter might need to evict an old WAL buffer
1507 * to make room for a new one, which in turn requires WALWriteLock.
1508 */
1509static XLogRecPtr
1511{
1517 int i;
1518
1519 if (MyProc == NULL)
1520 elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
1521
1522 /*
1523 * Check if there's any work to do. Use a barrier to ensure we get the
1524 * freshest value.
1525 */
1527 if (upto <= inserted)
1528 return inserted;
1529
1530 /* Read the current insert position */
1531 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1532 bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1533 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1535
1536 /*
1537 * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
1538 * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
1539 * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
1540 * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
1541 * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
1542 * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
1543 */
1544 if (upto > reservedUpto)
1545 {
1546 ereport(LOG,
1547 errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1550 }
1551
1552 /*
1553 * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
1554 * than 'upto'.
1555 *
1556 * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
1557 * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
1558 * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
1559 * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
1560 */
1562 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1563 {
1565
1566 do
1567 {
1568 /*
1569 * See if this insertion is in progress. LWLockWaitForVar will
1570 * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
1571 * by a LWLockUpdateVar call. When a lock is initially acquired,
1572 * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
1573 * know where it's inserting yet. We will have to wait for it. If
1574 * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
1575 * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
1576 * calling LWLockUpdateVar. But if it has to sleep, it will
1577 * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
1578 * sleeping.
1579 *
1580 * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
1581 * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called. The lack of
1582 * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
1583 * "unused" that have since become used. This is fine because
1584 * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
1585 * want to wait on anyway. Not taking a lock to acquire the
1586 * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
1587 * insertingAt values. This is also fine, because if we read a
1588 * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
1589 * contains atomic operations.
1590 */
1591 if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
1594 {
1595 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
1597 break;
1598 }
1599
1600 /*
1601 * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
1602 * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
1603 */
1604 } while (insertingat < upto);
1605
1608 }
1609
1610 /*
1611 * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
1612 * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
1613 * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
1614 */
1616 finishedUpto);
1617
1618 return finishedUpto;
1619}
1620
1621/*
1622 * Get a pointer to the right location in the WAL buffer containing the
1623 * given XLogRecPtr.
1624 *
1625 * If the page is not initialized yet, it is initialized. That might require
1626 * evicting an old dirty buffer from the buffer cache, which means I/O.
1627 *
1628 * The caller must ensure that the page containing the requested location
1629 * isn't evicted yet, and won't be evicted. The way to ensure that is to
1630 * hold onto a WAL insertion lock with the insertingAt position set to
1631 * something <= ptr. GetXLogBuffer() will update insertingAt if it needs
1632 * to evict an old page from the buffer. (This means that once you call
1633 * GetXLogBuffer() with a given 'ptr', you must not access anything before
1634 * that point anymore, and must not call GetXLogBuffer() with an older 'ptr'
1635 * later, because older buffers might be recycled already)
1636 */
1637static char *
1639{
1640 int idx;
1641 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1642 static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
1643 static char *cachedPos = NULL;
1645
1646 /*
1647 * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
1648 * page as last time.
1649 */
1650 if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
1651 {
1653 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1654 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1655 }
1656
1657 /*
1658 * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
1659 * particular buffer. That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
1660 * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
1661 */
1662 idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
1663
1664 /*
1665 * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
1666 * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
1667 * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
1668 * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
1669 * that doesn't happen.
1670 *
1671 * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
1672 * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
1673 * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
1674 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
1675 * we're looking for.
1676 */
1677 expectedEndPtr = ptr;
1679
1681 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1682 {
1684
1685 /*
1686 * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
1687 * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
1688 *
1689 * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
1690 * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
1691 * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
1692 * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
1693 * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
1694 * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
1695 * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
1696 * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
1697 * the page header.
1698 */
1699 if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
1702 else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
1705 else
1706 initializedUpto = ptr;
1707
1709
1710 AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
1712
1713 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1714 elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%08X",
1715 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
1716 }
1717 else
1718 {
1719 /*
1720 * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
1721 * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
1722 */
1724 }
1725
1726 /*
1727 * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
1728 * offset within the page.
1729 */
1730 cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1732
1734 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1735
1736 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1737}
1738
1739/*
1740 * Read WAL data directly from WAL buffers, if available. Returns the number
1741 * of bytes read successfully.
1742 *
1743 * Fewer than 'count' bytes may be read if some of the requested WAL data has
1744 * already been evicted.
1745 *
1746 * No locks are taken.
1747 *
1748 * Caller should ensure that it reads no further than LogwrtResult.Write
1749 * (which should have been updated by the caller when determining how far to
1750 * read). The 'tli' argument is only used as a convenient safety check so that
1751 * callers do not read from WAL buffers on a historical timeline.
1752 */
1753Size
1755 TimeLineID tli)
1756{
1757 char *pdst = dstbuf;
1758 XLogRecPtr recptr = startptr;
1760 Size nbytes = count;
1761
1763 return 0;
1764
1765 Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(startptr));
1766
1767 /*
1768 * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
1769 * buffers before we try to read it.
1770 */
1772 if (startptr + count > inserted)
1773 ereport(ERROR,
1774 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1775 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
1777
1778 /*
1779 * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
1780 * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
1781 * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
1782 *
1783 * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
1784 * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
1785 * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
1786 * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
1787 * happens between the two verification steps.
1788 *
1789 * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
1790 * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
1791 */
1792 while (nbytes > 0)
1793 {
1794 uint32 offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1797 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1798 const char *page;
1799 const char *psrc;
1801
1802 /*
1803 * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
1804 * correct page is present.
1805 */
1806 expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1807
1808 /*
1809 * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
1810 * the WAL buffers.
1811 */
1813 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1814 break;
1815
1816 /*
1817 * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
1818 * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
1819 * determine how much data to read from this page.
1820 */
1821 page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1822 psrc = page + offset;
1823 npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1824
1825 /*
1826 * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
1827 * reordered.
1828 */
1830
1831 /* data copy */
1833
1834 /*
1835 * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
1836 * reordered.
1837 */
1839
1840 /*
1841 * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
1842 * evicted while we were copying the data.
1843 */
1845 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1846 break;
1847
1848 pdst += npagebytes;
1849 recptr += npagebytes;
1850 nbytes -= npagebytes;
1851 }
1852
1853 Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
1854
1855 return pdst - dstbuf;
1856}
1857
1858/*
1859 * Converts a "usable byte position" to XLogRecPtr. A usable byte position
1860 * is the position starting from the beginning of WAL, excluding all WAL
1861 * page headers.
1862 */
1863static XLogRecPtr
1865{
1870 XLogRecPtr result;
1871
1874
1876 {
1877 /* fits on first page of segment */
1879 }
1880 else
1881 {
1882 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1885
1888
1890 }
1891
1893
1894 return result;
1895}
1896
1897/*
1898 * Like XLogBytePosToRecPtr, but if the position is at a page boundary,
1899 * returns a pointer to the beginning of the page (ie. before page header),
1900 * not to where the first xlog record on that page would go to. This is used
1901 * when converting a pointer to the end of a record.
1902 */
1903static XLogRecPtr
1905{
1910 XLogRecPtr result;
1911
1914
1916 {
1917 /* fits on first page of segment */
1918 if (bytesleft == 0)
1919 seg_offset = 0;
1920 else
1922 }
1923 else
1924 {
1925 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1928
1931
1932 if (bytesleft == 0)
1934 else
1936 }
1937
1939
1940 return result;
1941}
1942
1943/*
1944 * Convert an XLogRecPtr to a "usable byte position".
1945 */
1946static uint64
1948{
1951 uint32 offset;
1952 uint64 result;
1953
1955
1957 offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1958
1959 if (fullpages == 0)
1960 {
1961 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
1962 if (offset > 0)
1963 {
1964 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
1965 result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1966 }
1967 }
1968 else
1969 {
1970 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
1971 (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
1972 (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage; /* full pages */
1973 if (offset > 0)
1974 {
1975 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1976 result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1977 }
1978 }
1979
1980 return result;
1981}
1982
1983/*
1984 * Initialize XLOG buffers, writing out old buffers if they still contain
1985 * unwritten data, upto the page containing 'upto'. Or if 'opportunistic' is
1986 * true, initialize as many pages as we can without having to write out
1987 * unwritten data. Any new pages are initialized to zeros, with pages headers
1988 * initialized properly.
1989 */
1990static void
1992{
1994 int nextidx;
2000 int npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
2001
2003
2004 /*
2005 * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
2006 * already.
2007 */
2009 {
2011
2012 /*
2013 * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
2014 * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet). Fall through if it's
2015 * already written out.
2016 */
2019 {
2020 /*
2021 * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
2022 * as we can without flushing, give up now.
2023 */
2024 if (opportunistic)
2025 break;
2026
2027 /* Advance shared memory write request position */
2032
2033 /*
2034 * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
2035 * need to write it or if someone else already did.
2036 */
2039 {
2040 /*
2041 * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
2042 * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
2043 * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
2044 * deadlock.
2045 */
2047
2049
2051
2054 {
2055 /* OK, someone wrote it already */
2057 }
2058 else
2059 {
2060 /* Have to write it ourselves */
2062 WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
2064 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
2068
2069 /*
2070 * Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data, per
2071 * update of pgWalUsage.
2072 */
2073 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
2074 }
2075 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
2077 continue;
2078 }
2079 }
2080
2081 /*
2082 * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
2083 * next output page.
2084 */
2087
2089
2091
2092 /*
2093 * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
2094 * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
2095 * zeroed but look valid.
2096 */
2099
2100 /*
2101 * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
2102 * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
2103 */
2105
2106 /*
2107 * Fill the new page's header
2108 */
2109 NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
2110
2111 /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2112 NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
2113 NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
2114
2115 /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2116
2117 /*
2118 * If online backup is not in progress, mark the header to indicate
2119 * that WAL records beginning in this page have removable backup
2120 * blocks. This allows the WAL archiver to know whether it is safe to
2121 * compress archived WAL data by transforming full-block records into
2122 * the non-full-block format. It is sufficient to record this at the
2123 * page level because we force a page switch (in fact a segment
2124 * switch) when starting a backup, so the flag will be off before any
2125 * records can be written during the backup. At the end of a backup,
2126 * the last page will be marked as all unsafe when perhaps only part
2127 * is unsafe, but at worst the archiver would miss the opportunity to
2128 * compress a few records.
2129 */
2130 if (Insert->runningBackups == 0)
2131 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE;
2132
2133 /*
2134 * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
2135 */
2136 if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
2137 {
2139
2141 NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
2142 NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2143 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
2144 }
2145
2146 /*
2147 * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
2148 * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
2149 * holding a lock.
2150 */
2152
2155
2156 npages++;
2157 }
2159
2160#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2161 if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
2162 {
2163 elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%08X",
2165 }
2166#endif
2167}
2168
2169/*
2170 * Calculate CheckPointSegments based on max_wal_size_mb and
2171 * checkpoint_completion_target.
2172 */
2173static void
2175{
2176 double target;
2177
2178 /*-------
2179 * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
2180 * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
2181 *
2182 * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
2183 * WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
2184 * secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
2185 * only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
2186 * one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
2187 * many smaller databases.)
2188 * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
2189 * number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
2190 *-------
2191 */
2194
2195 /* round down */
2196 CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
2197
2198 if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
2200}
2201
2202void
2208
2209void
2215
2216bool
2218{
2220 {
2221 GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
2222 return false;
2223 }
2224
2225 return true;
2226}
2227
2228/*
2229 * At a checkpoint, how many WAL segments to recycle as preallocated future
2230 * XLOG segments? Returns the highest segment that should be preallocated.
2231 */
2232static XLogSegNo
2234{
2237 double distance;
2239
2240 /*
2241 * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
2242 * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
2243 * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
2244 */
2249
2250 /*
2251 * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
2252 * estimated end of next checkpoint.
2253 *
2254 * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
2255 * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
2256 * every checkpoint.
2257 */
2259 /* add 10% for good measure. */
2260 distance *= 1.10;
2261
2262 recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
2264
2265 if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
2267 if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
2269
2270 return recycleSegNo;
2271}
2272
2273/*
2274 * Check whether we've consumed enough xlog space that a checkpoint is needed.
2275 *
2276 * new_segno indicates a log file that has just been filled up (or read
2277 * during recovery). We measure the distance from RedoRecPtr to new_segno
2278 * and see if that exceeds CheckPointSegments.
2279 *
2280 * Note: it is caller's responsibility that RedoRecPtr is up-to-date.
2281 */
2282bool
2284{
2286
2288
2290 return true;
2291 return false;
2292}
2293
2294/*
2295 * Write and/or fsync the log at least as far as WriteRqst indicates.
2296 *
2297 * If flexible == true, we don't have to write as far as WriteRqst, but
2298 * may stop at any convenient boundary (such as a cache or logfile boundary).
2299 * This option allows us to avoid uselessly issuing multiple writes when a
2300 * single one would do.
2301 *
2302 * Must be called with WALWriteLock held. WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqst)
2303 * must be called before grabbing the lock, to make sure the data is ready to
2304 * write.
2305 */
2306static void
2308{
2309 bool ispartialpage;
2310 bool last_iteration;
2311 bool finishing_seg;
2312 int curridx;
2313 int npages;
2314 int startidx;
2316
2317 /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
2319
2320 /*
2321 * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
2322 */
2324
2325 /*
2326 * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
2327 * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
2328 * write() call. npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
2329 * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
2330 * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
2331 * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
2332 * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
2333 */
2334 npages = 0;
2335 startidx = 0;
2336 startoffset = 0;
2337
2338 /*
2339 * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
2340 * consider writing. Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
2341 * page, or last partially written page.
2342 */
2344
2345 while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
2346 {
2347 /*
2348 * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process. This could happen
2349 * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
2350 * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
2351 */
2353
2354 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
2355 elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%08X is past end of log %X/%08X",
2358
2359 /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
2362
2365 {
2366 /*
2367 * Switch to new logfile segment. We cannot have any pending
2368 * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
2369 */
2370 Assert(npages == 0);
2371 if (openLogFile >= 0)
2372 XLogFileClose();
2375 openLogTLI = tli;
2376
2377 /* create/use new log file */
2380 }
2381
2382 /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
2383 if (openLogFile < 0)
2384 {
2387 openLogTLI = tli;
2390 }
2391
2392 /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
2393 if (npages == 0)
2394 {
2395 /* first of group */
2396 startidx = curridx;
2399 }
2400 npages++;
2401
2402 /*
2403 * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
2404 * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
2405 * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
2406 * segment.
2407 */
2409
2412
2413 if (last_iteration ||
2416 {
2417 char *from;
2418 Size nbytes;
2419 Size nleft;
2422
2423 /* OK to write the page(s) */
2424 from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2425 nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2426 nleft = nbytes;
2427 do
2428 {
2429 errno = 0;
2430
2431 /*
2432 * Measure I/O timing to write WAL data, for pg_stat_io.
2433 */
2435
2439
2441 IOOP_WRITE, start, 1, written);
2442
2443 if (written <= 0)
2444 {
2445 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
2446 int save_errno;
2447
2448 if (errno == EINTR)
2449 continue;
2450
2451 save_errno = errno;
2454 errno = save_errno;
2455 ereport(PANIC,
2457 errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
2459 }
2460 nleft -= written;
2461 from += written;
2463 } while (nleft > 0);
2464
2465 npages = 0;
2466
2467 /*
2468 * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
2469 * fsync the segment immediately. This avoids having to go back
2470 * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
2471 * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
2472 * perform this fsync.
2473 *
2474 * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
2475 * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
2476 * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
2477 * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
2478 * checkpoint.
2479 */
2480 if (finishing_seg)
2481 {
2483
2484 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2486
2487 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; /* end of page */
2488
2489 if (XLogArchivingActive())
2491
2494
2495 /*
2496 * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
2497 * the last one. For speed, we first check using the local
2498 * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
2499 * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
2500 * recheck.
2501 */
2503 {
2504 (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
2507 }
2508 }
2509 }
2510
2511 if (ispartialpage)
2512 {
2513 /* Only asked to write a partial page */
2515 break;
2516 }
2518
2519 /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
2520 if (flexible && npages == 0)
2521 break;
2522 }
2523
2524 Assert(npages == 0);
2525
2526 /*
2527 * If asked to flush, do so
2528 */
2529 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
2531 {
2532 /*
2533 * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
2534 * have no open file or the wrong one. However, we do not need to
2535 * fsync more than one file.
2536 */
2539 {
2540 if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
2543 XLogFileClose();
2544 if (openLogFile < 0)
2545 {
2548 openLogTLI = tli;
2551 }
2552
2554 }
2555
2556 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2558
2560 }
2561
2562 /*
2563 * Update shared-memory status
2564 *
2565 * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
2566 * 'result' values. This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
2567 * code in a couple of places.
2568 */
2575
2576 /*
2577 * We write Write first, bar, then Flush. When reading, the opposite must
2578 * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
2579 * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
2580 */
2584
2585#ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
2586 {
2590
2596
2597 /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
2598 Assert(Write >= Flush);
2599
2600 /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
2601 Assert(Insert >= Write);
2602 }
2603#endif
2604}
2605
2606/*
2607 * Record the LSN for an asynchronous transaction commit/abort
2608 * and nudge the WALWriter if there is work for it to do.
2609 * (This should not be called for synchronous commits.)
2610 */
2611void
2613{
2614 XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
2615 bool sleeping;
2616 bool wakeup = false;
2618
2622 if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
2623 XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
2625
2626 /*
2627 * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
2628 * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
2629 */
2630 if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
2631 return;
2632
2633 /*
2634 * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
2635 * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
2636 * amount of time. Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
2637 * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
2638 */
2639 if (sleeping)
2640 wakeup = true;
2641 else
2642 {
2643 int flushblocks;
2644
2646
2647 flushblocks =
2649
2651 wakeup = true;
2652 }
2653
2654 if (wakeup)
2655 {
2656 volatile PROC_HDR *procglobal = ProcGlobal;
2657 ProcNumber walwriterProc = procglobal->walwriterProc;
2658
2659 if (walwriterProc != INVALID_PROC_NUMBER)
2660 SetLatch(&GetPGProcByNumber(walwriterProc)->procLatch);
2661 }
2662}
2663
2664/*
2665 * Record the LSN up to which we can remove WAL because it's not required by
2666 * any replication slot.
2667 */
2668void
2675
2676
2677/*
2678 * Return the oldest LSN we must retain to satisfy the needs of some
2679 * replication slot.
2680 */
2683{
2684 XLogRecPtr retval;
2685
2689
2690 return retval;
2691}
2692
2693/*
2694 * Advance minRecoveryPoint in control file.
2695 *
2696 * If we crash during recovery, we must reach this point again before the
2697 * database is consistent.
2698 *
2699 * If 'force' is true, 'lsn' argument is ignored. Otherwise, minRecoveryPoint
2700 * is only updated if it's not already greater than or equal to 'lsn'.
2701 */
2702static void
2704{
2705 /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
2706 if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
2707 return;
2708
2709 /*
2710 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
2711 * i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control file's
2712 * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
2713 * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
2714 * updated until crash recovery finishes. We only do this for the startup
2715 * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
2716 * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
2717 * available is replayed in this case. This also saves from extra locks
2718 * taken on the control file from the startup process.
2719 */
2721 {
2722 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2723 return;
2724 }
2725
2727
2728 /* update local copy */
2731
2733 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2734 else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2735 {
2738
2739 /*
2740 * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
2741 * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
2742 * would suffice for correctness. This also allows the 'force' case
2743 * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
2744 *
2745 * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
2746 * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
2747 * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page. Accepting such a
2748 * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
2749 * all. Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
2750 * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
2751 */
2753 if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2754 elog(WARNING,
2755 "xlog min recovery request %X/%08X is past current point %X/%08X",
2757
2758 /* update control file */
2760 {
2766
2768 errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%08X on timeline %u",
2771 }
2772 }
2774}
2775
2776/*
2777 * Ensure that all XLOG data through the given position is flushed to disk.
2778 *
2779 * NOTE: this differs from XLogWrite mainly in that the WALWriteLock is not
2780 * already held, and we try to avoid acquiring it if possible.
2781 */
2782void
2784{
2788
2789 /*
2790 * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL. Therefore, instead of
2791 * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
2792 * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
2793 * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
2794 * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
2795 */
2796 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
2797 {
2798 UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
2799 return;
2800 }
2801
2802 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
2803 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2804 return;
2805
2806#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2807 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
2808 elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%08X; write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
2809 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2812#endif
2813
2815
2816 /*
2817 * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
2818 * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
2819 * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
2820 * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
2821 * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
2822 */
2823
2824 /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
2825 WriteRqstPtr = record;
2826
2827 /*
2828 * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
2829 * for us.
2830 */
2831 for (;;)
2832 {
2834
2835 /* done already? */
2837 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2838 break;
2839
2840 /*
2841 * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
2842 * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
2843 */
2845 if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
2849
2850 /*
2851 * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
2852 * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
2853 * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
2854 * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
2855 * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
2856 */
2858 {
2859 /*
2860 * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
2861 * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
2862 * us already.
2863 */
2864 continue;
2865 }
2866
2867 /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
2869 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2870 {
2872 break;
2873 }
2874
2875 /*
2876 * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
2877 * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
2878 * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
2879 * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
2880 *
2881 * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
2882 * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
2883 */
2884 if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
2886 {
2890
2891 /*
2892 * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
2893 * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
2894 * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
2895 * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
2896 * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
2897 * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
2898 * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
2899 * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
2900 */
2902 }
2903
2904 /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
2905 WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
2906 WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
2907
2908 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
2909
2911 /* done */
2912 break;
2913 }
2914
2916
2917 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
2919
2920 /*
2921 * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
2922 */
2923 if (waitLSNState &&
2927
2928 /*
2929 * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
2930 * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
2931 * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
2932 *
2933 * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
2934 * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
2935 * the whole system due to corruption on one data page. In particular, if
2936 * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
2937 * unable to restart the database at all! (This scenario actually
2938 * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.) As of 8.4, bad
2939 * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
2940 * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
2941 * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
2942 * bad LSN.
2943 *
2944 * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
2945 * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section. However,
2946 * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
2947 * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
2948 */
2949 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
2950 elog(ERROR,
2951 "xlog flush request %X/%08X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%08X",
2952 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2954
2955 /*
2956 * Cross-check XLogNeedsFlush(). Some of the checks of XLogFlush() and
2957 * XLogNeedsFlush() are duplicated, and this assertion ensures that these
2958 * remain consistent.
2959 */
2960 Assert(!XLogNeedsFlush(record));
2961}
2962
2963/*
2964 * Write & flush xlog, but without specifying exactly where to.
2965 *
2966 * We normally write only completed blocks; but if there is nothing to do on
2967 * that basis, we check for unwritten async commits in the current incomplete
2968 * block, and write through the latest one of those. Thus, if async commits
2969 * are not being used, we will write complete blocks only.
2970 *
2971 * If, based on the above, there's anything to write we do so immediately. But
2972 * to avoid calling fsync, fdatasync et. al. at a rate that'd impact
2973 * concurrent IO, we only flush WAL every wal_writer_delay ms, or if there's
2974 * more than wal_writer_flush_after unflushed blocks.
2975 *
2976 * We can guarantee that async commits reach disk after at most three
2977 * wal_writer_delay cycles. (When flushing complete blocks, we allow XLogWrite
2978 * to write "flexibly", meaning it can stop at the end of the buffer ring;
2979 * this makes a difference only with very high load or long wal_writer_delay,
2980 * but imposes one extra cycle for the worst case for async commits.)
2981 *
2982 * This routine is invoked periodically by the background walwriter process.
2983 *
2984 * Returns true if there was any work to do, even if we skipped flushing due
2985 * to wal_writer_delay/wal_writer_flush_after.
2986 */
2987bool
2989{
2991 bool flexible = true;
2992 static TimestampTz lastflush;
2994 int flushblocks;
2996
2997 /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
2998 if (RecoveryInProgress())
2999 return false;
3000
3001 /*
3002 * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
3003 * so we can read it without a lock.
3004 */
3006
3007 /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
3011
3012 /* back off to last completed page boundary */
3013 WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
3014
3015 /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
3017 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3018 {
3022 flexible = false; /* ensure it all gets written */
3023 }
3024
3025 /*
3026 * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
3027 * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
3028 * preventing the file from being deleted.
3029 */
3030 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3031 {
3032 if (openLogFile >= 0)
3033 {
3036 {
3037 XLogFileClose();
3038 }
3039 }
3040 return false;
3041 }
3042
3043 /*
3044 * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
3045 * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
3046 *
3047 * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
3048 * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up. Make sure the
3049 * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
3050 */
3052 flushblocks =
3054
3055 if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
3056 {
3057 /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
3058 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3059 lastflush = now;
3060 }
3062 {
3063 /*
3064 * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
3065 * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
3066 * commit to hit disk.
3067 */
3068 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3069 lastflush = now;
3070 }
3071 else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
3072 {
3073 /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
3074 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3075 lastflush = now;
3076 }
3077 else
3078 {
3079 /* no flushing, this time round */
3081 }
3082
3083#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
3084 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
3085 elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%08X; flush: %X/%08X, current is write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
3090#endif
3091
3093
3094 /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
3098 if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
3100 {
3102 }
3104
3106
3107 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
3109
3110 /*
3111 * If we flushed an LSN that someone was waiting for, notify the waiters.
3112 */
3113 if (waitLSNState &&
3117
3118 /*
3119 * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
3120 * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
3121 */
3123
3124 /*
3125 * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
3126 * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
3127 * avoid hibernating too early.
3128 */
3129 return true;
3130}
3131
3132/*
3133 * Test whether XLOG data has been flushed up to (at least) the given
3134 * position, or whether the minimum recovery point has been updated past
3135 * the given position.
3136 *
3137 * Returns true if a flush is still needed, or if the minimum recovery point
3138 * must be updated.
3139 *
3140 * It is possible that someone else is already in the process of flushing
3141 * that far, or has updated the minimum recovery point up to the given
3142 * position.
3143 */
3144bool
3146{
3147 /*
3148 * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
3149 * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
3150 * would need to be updated.
3151 *
3152 * Using XLogInsertAllowed() rather than RecoveryInProgress() matters for
3153 * the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, where WAL data is flushed.
3154 * This check should be consistent with the one in XLogFlush().
3155 */
3156 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
3157 {
3158 /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
3160 return false;
3161
3162 /*
3163 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
3164 * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control
3165 * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
3166 * here too. This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
3167 * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
3168 * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
3169 */
3171 {
3172 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3173 return false;
3174 }
3175
3176 /*
3177 * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
3178 * just return a conservative guess.
3179 */
3181 return true;
3185
3186 /*
3187 * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
3188 * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
3189 * file value if crash recovery is still running.
3190 */
3192 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3193
3194 /* check again */
3196 return false;
3197 else
3198 return true;
3199 }
3200
3201 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
3202 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3203 return false;
3204
3205 /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
3207
3208 /* check again */
3209 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3210 return false;
3211
3212 return true;
3213}
3214
3215/*
3216 * Try to make a given XLOG file segment exist.
3217 *
3218 * logsegno: identify segment.
3219 *
3220 * *added: on return, true if this call raised the number of extant segments.
3221 *
3222 * path: on return, this char[MAXPGPATH] has the path to the logsegno file.
3223 *
3224 * Returns -1 or FD of opened file. A -1 here is not an error; a caller
3225 * wanting an open segment should attempt to open "path", which usually will
3226 * succeed. (This is weird, but it's efficient for the callers.)
3227 */
3228static int
3230 bool *added, char *path)
3231{
3232 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3235 int fd;
3236 int save_errno;
3239
3240 Assert(logtli != 0);
3241
3243
3244 /*
3245 * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
3246 */
3247 *added = false;
3250 if (fd < 0)
3251 {
3252 if (errno != ENOENT)
3253 ereport(ERROR,
3255 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3256 }
3257 else
3258 return fd;
3259
3260 /*
3261 * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment. NOTE: it is possible that
3262 * another process is doing the same thing. If so, we will end up
3263 * pre-creating an extra log segment. That seems OK, and better than
3264 * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
3265 */
3266 elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
3267
3268 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3269
3270 unlink(tmppath);
3271
3274
3275 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3277 if (fd < 0)
3278 ereport(ERROR,
3280 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3281
3282 /* Measure I/O timing when initializing segment */
3284
3286 save_errno = 0;
3287 if (wal_init_zero)
3288 {
3289 ssize_t rc;
3290
3291 /*
3292 * Zero-fill the file. With this setting, we do this the hard way to
3293 * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated. On
3294 * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
3295 * doesn't allocate intermediate space. This way, we know that we
3296 * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
3297 * indirect blocks are down on disk. Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
3298 * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
3299 */
3301
3302 if (rc < 0)
3303 save_errno = errno;
3304 }
3305 else
3306 {
3307 /*
3308 * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
3309 * enough.
3310 */
3311 errno = 0;
3312 if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
3313 {
3314 /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
3316 }
3317 }
3319
3320 /*
3321 * A full segment worth of data is written when using wal_init_zero. One
3322 * byte is written when not using it.
3323 */
3325 io_start, 1,
3327
3328 if (save_errno)
3329 {
3330 /*
3331 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3332 */
3333 unlink(tmppath);
3334
3335 close(fd);
3336
3337 errno = save_errno;
3338
3339 ereport(ERROR,
3341 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3342 }
3343
3344 /* Measure I/O timing when flushing segment */
3346
3348 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3349 {
3350 save_errno = errno;
3351 close(fd);
3352 errno = save_errno;
3353 ereport(ERROR,
3355 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3356 }
3358
3360 IOOP_FSYNC, io_start, 1, 0);
3361
3362 if (close(fd) != 0)
3363 ereport(ERROR,
3365 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3366
3367 /*
3368 * Now move the segment into place with its final name. Cope with
3369 * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
3370 * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
3371 */
3373
3374 /*
3375 * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
3376 * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
3377 * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
3378 * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
3379 * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
3380 * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
3381 * CheckPointSegments.
3382 */
3385 logtli))
3386 {
3387 *added = true;
3388 elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
3389 }
3390 else
3391 {
3392 /*
3393 * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
3394 * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
3395 * caller opening the file may fail.
3396 */
3397 unlink(tmppath);
3398 elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
3399 }
3400
3401 return -1;
3402}
3403
3404/*
3405 * Create a new XLOG file segment, or open a pre-existing one.
3406 *
3407 * logsegno: identify segment to be created/opened.
3408 *
3409 * Returns FD of opened file.
3410 *
3411 * Note: errors here are ERROR not PANIC because we might or might not be
3412 * inside a critical section (eg, during checkpoint there is no reason to
3413 * take down the system on failure). They will promote to PANIC if we are
3414 * in a critical section.
3415 */
3416int
3418{
3419 bool ignore_added;
3420 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3421 int fd;
3422
3423 Assert(logtli != 0);
3424
3426 if (fd >= 0)
3427 return fd;
3428
3429 /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
3432 if (fd < 0)
3433 ereport(ERROR,
3435 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3436 return fd;
3437}
3438
3439/*
3440 * Create a new XLOG file segment by copying a pre-existing one.
3441 *
3442 * destsegno: identify segment to be created.
3443 *
3444 * srcTLI, srcsegno: identify segment to be copied (could be from
3445 * a different timeline)
3446 *
3447 * upto: how much of the source file to copy (the rest is filled with
3448 * zeros)
3449 *
3450 * Currently this is only used during recovery, and so there are no locking
3451 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to avoid
3452 * emplacing a bogus file.
3453 */
3454static void
3457 int upto)
3458{
3459 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3460 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3461 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
3462 int srcfd;
3463 int fd;
3464 int nbytes;
3465
3466 /*
3467 * Open the source file
3468 */
3471 if (srcfd < 0)
3472 ereport(ERROR,
3474 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3475
3476 /*
3477 * Copy into a temp file name.
3478 */
3479 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3480
3481 unlink(tmppath);
3482
3483 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3485 if (fd < 0)
3486 ereport(ERROR,
3488 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3489
3490 /*
3491 * Do the data copying.
3492 */
3493 for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
3494 {
3495 int nread;
3496
3497 nread = upto - nbytes;
3498
3499 /*
3500 * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
3501 * zeros.
3502 */
3503 if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
3504 memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
3505
3506 if (nread > 0)
3507 {
3508 int r;
3509
3510 if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
3511 nread = sizeof(buffer);
3513 r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
3514 if (r != nread)
3515 {
3516 if (r < 0)
3517 ereport(ERROR,
3519 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
3520 path)));
3521 else
3522 ereport(ERROR,
3524 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
3525 path, r, (Size) nread)));
3526 }
3528 }
3529 errno = 0;
3531 if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
3532 {
3533 int save_errno = errno;
3534
3535 /*
3536 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3537 */
3538 unlink(tmppath);
3539 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
3541
3542 ereport(ERROR,
3544 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3545 }
3547 }
3548
3550 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3553 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3555
3556 if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
3557 ereport(ERROR,
3559 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3560
3561 if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
3562 ereport(ERROR,
3564 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3565
3566 /*
3567 * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
3568 */
3570 elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
3571}
3572
3573/*
3574 * Install a new XLOG segment file as a current or future log segment.
3575 *
3576 * This is used both to install a newly-created segment (which has a temp
3577 * filename while it's being created) and to recycle an old segment.
3578 *
3579 * *segno: identify segment to install as (or first possible target).
3580 * When find_free is true, this is modified on return to indicate the
3581 * actual installation location or last segment searched.
3582 *
3583 * tmppath: initial name of file to install. It will be renamed into place.
3584 *
3585 * find_free: if true, install the new segment at the first empty segno
3586 * number at or after the passed numbers. If false, install the new segment
3587 * exactly where specified, deleting any existing segment file there.
3588 *
3589 * max_segno: maximum segment number to install the new file as. Fail if no
3590 * free slot is found between *segno and max_segno. (Ignored when find_free
3591 * is false.)
3592 *
3593 * tli: The timeline on which the new segment should be installed.
3594 *
3595 * Returns true if the file was installed successfully. false indicates that
3596 * max_segno limit was exceeded, the startup process has disabled this
3597 * function for now, or an error occurred while renaming the file into place.
3598 */
3599static bool
3602{
3603 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3604 struct stat stat_buf;
3605
3606 Assert(tli != 0);
3607
3608 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3609
3612 {
3614 return false;
3615 }
3616
3617 if (!find_free)
3618 {
3619 /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
3620 durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
3621 }
3622 else
3623 {
3624 /* Find a free slot to put it in */
3625 while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
3626 {
3627 if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
3628 {
3629 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
3631 return false;
3632 }
3633 (*segno)++;
3634 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3635 }
3636 }
3637
3638 Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
3639 if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
3640 {
3642 /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
3643 return false;
3644 }
3645
3647
3648 return true;
3649}
3650
3651/*
3652 * Open a pre-existing logfile segment for writing.
3653 */
3654int
3656{
3657 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3658 int fd;
3659
3660 XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
3661
3664 if (fd < 0)
3665 ereport(PANIC,
3667 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3668
3669 return fd;
3670}
3671
3672/*
3673 * Close the current logfile segment for writing.
3674 */
3675static void
3677{
3678 Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
3679
3680 /*
3681 * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
3682 * the OS to release any cached pages. But do not do so if WAL archiving
3683 * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
3684 * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
3685 */
3686#if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
3687 if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
3689#endif
3690
3691 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
3692 {
3693 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
3694 int save_errno = errno;
3695
3697 errno = save_errno;
3698 ereport(PANIC,
3700 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
3701 }
3702
3703 openLogFile = -1;
3705}
3706
3707/*
3708 * Preallocate log files beyond the specified log endpoint.
3709 *
3710 * XXX this is currently extremely conservative, since it forces only one
3711 * future log segment to exist, and even that only if we are 75% done with
3712 * the current one. This is only appropriate for very low-WAL-volume systems.
3713 * High-volume systems will be OK once they've built up a sufficient set of
3714 * recycled log segments, but the startup transient is likely to include
3715 * a lot of segment creations by foreground processes, which is not so good.
3716 *
3717 * XLogFileInitInternal() can ereport(ERROR). All known causes indicate big
3718 * trouble; for example, a full filesystem is one cause. The checkpoint WAL
3719 * and/or ControlFile updates already completed. If a RequestCheckpoint()
3720 * initiated the present checkpoint and an ERROR ends this function, the
3721 * command that called RequestCheckpoint() fails. That's not ideal, but it's
3722 * not worth contorting more functions to use caller-specified elevel values.
3723 * (With or without RequestCheckpoint(), an ERROR forestalls some inessential
3724 * reporting and resource reclamation.)
3725 */
3726static void
3728{
3730 int lf;
3731 bool added;
3732 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3733 uint64 offset;
3734
3736 return; /* unlocked check says no */
3737
3739 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
3740 if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
3741 {
3742 _logSegNo++;
3743 lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
3744 if (lf >= 0)
3745 close(lf);
3746 if (added)
3748 }
3749}
3750
3751/*
3752 * Throws an error if the given log segment has already been removed or
3753 * recycled. The caller should only pass a segment that it knows to have
3754 * existed while the server has been running, as this function always
3755 * succeeds if no WAL segments have been removed since startup.
3756 * 'tli' is only used in the error message.
3757 *
3758 * Note: this function guarantees to keep errno unchanged on return.
3759 * This supports callers that use this to possibly deliver a better
3760 * error message about a missing file, while still being able to throw
3761 * a normal file-access error afterwards, if this does return.
3762 */
3763void
3765{
3766 int save_errno = errno;
3767 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3768
3770 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3772
3773 if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
3774 {
3775 char filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
3776
3778 errno = save_errno;
3779 ereport(ERROR,
3781 errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
3782 filename)));
3783 }
3784 errno = save_errno;
3785}
3786
3787/*
3788 * Return the last WAL segment removed, or 0 if no segment has been removed
3789 * since startup.
3790 *
3791 * NB: the result can be out of date arbitrarily fast, the caller has to deal
3792 * with that.
3793 */
3796{
3797 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3798
3800 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3802
3803 return lastRemovedSegNo;
3804}
3805
3806/*
3807 * Return the oldest WAL segment on the given TLI that still exists in
3808 * XLOGDIR, or 0 if none.
3809 */
3812{
3813 DIR *xldir;
3814 struct dirent *xlde;
3816
3818 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3819 {
3822
3823 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
3824 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3825 continue;
3826
3827 /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
3830
3831 /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
3832 if (tli != file_tli)
3833 continue;
3834
3835 /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
3836 if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
3838 }
3839
3840 FreeDir(xldir);
3841 return oldest_segno;
3842}
3843
3844/*
3845 * Update the last removed segno pointer in shared memory, to reflect that the
3846 * given XLOG file has been removed.
3847 */
3848static void
3850{
3851 uint32 tli;
3852 XLogSegNo segno;
3853
3855
3857 if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
3858 XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
3860}
3861
3862/*
3863 * Remove all temporary log files in pg_wal
3864 *
3865 * This is called at the beginning of recovery after a previous crash,
3866 * at a point where no other processes write fresh WAL data.
3867 */
3868static void
3870{
3871 DIR *xldir;
3872 struct dirent *xlde;
3873
3874 elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
3875
3877 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3878 {
3879 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3880
3881 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
3882 continue;
3883
3884 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
3885 unlink(path);
3886 elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
3887 }
3888 FreeDir(xldir);
3889}
3890
3891/*
3892 * Recycle or remove all log files older or equal to passed segno.
3893 *
3894 * endptr is current (or recent) end of xlog, and lastredoptr is the
3895 * redo pointer of the last checkpoint. These are used to determine
3896 * whether we want to recycle rather than delete no-longer-wanted log files.
3897 *
3898 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled
3899 * segments should be reused for this timeline.
3900 */
3901static void
3904{
3905 DIR *xldir;
3906 struct dirent *xlde;
3907 char lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
3910
3911 /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
3914
3915 /*
3916 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
3917 * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
3918 * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
3919 */
3921
3922 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
3923 lastoff);
3924
3926
3927 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3928 {
3929 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
3930 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
3931 !IsPartialXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3932 continue;
3933
3934 /*
3935 * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
3936 * deciding whether a segment is still needed. This ensures that we
3937 * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
3938 * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
3939 * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
3940 * complicated.
3941 *
3942 * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
3943 * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
3944 */
3945 if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
3946 {
3947 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
3948 {
3949 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
3950 UpdateLastRemovedPtr(xlde->d_name);
3951
3953 }
3954 }
3955 }
3956
3957 FreeDir(xldir);
3958}
3959
3960/*
3961 * Recycle or remove WAL files that are not part of the given timeline's
3962 * history.
3963 *
3964 * This is called during recovery, whenever we switch to follow a new
3965 * timeline, and at the end of recovery when we create a new timeline. We
3966 * wouldn't otherwise care about extra WAL files lying in pg_wal, but they
3967 * might be leftover pre-allocated or recycled WAL segments on the old timeline
3968 * that we haven't used yet, and contain garbage. If we just leave them in
3969 * pg_wal, they will eventually be archived, and we can't let that happen.
3970 * Files that belong to our timeline history are valid, because we have
3971 * successfully replayed them, but from others we can't be sure.
3972 *
3973 * 'switchpoint' is the current point in WAL where we switch to new timeline,
3974 * and 'newTLI' is the new timeline we switch to.
3975 */
3976void
3978{
3979 DIR *xldir;
3980 struct dirent *xlde;
3981 char switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
3985
3986 /*
3987 * Initialize info about where to begin the work. This will recycle,
3988 * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
3989 */
3993
3994 /*
3995 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
3996 */
3998
3999 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
4000 switchseg);
4001
4003
4004 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4005 {
4006 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
4007 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
4008 continue;
4009
4010 /*
4011 * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
4012 * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
4013 * new timeline.
4014 */
4015 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
4016 strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
4017 {
4018 /*
4019 * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
4020 * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
4021 * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
4022 * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
4023 */
4024 if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
4026 }
4027 }
4028
4029 FreeDir(xldir);
4030}
4031
4032/*
4033 * Recycle or remove a log file that's no longer needed.
4034 *
4035 * segment_de is the dirent structure of the segment to recycle or remove.
4036 * recycleSegNo is the segment number to recycle up to. endlogSegNo is
4037 * the segment number of the current (or recent) end of WAL.
4038 *
4039 * endlogSegNo gets incremented if the segment is recycled so as it is not
4040 * checked again with future callers of this function.
4041 *
4042 * insertTLI is the current timeline for XLOG insertion. Any recycled segments
4043 * should be used for this timeline.
4044 */
4045static void
4049{
4050 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4051#ifdef WIN32
4052 char newpath[MAXPGPATH];
4053#endif
4054 const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
4055
4056 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
4057
4058 /*
4059 * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
4060 * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
4061 * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
4062 */
4063 if (wal_recycle &&
4065 XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
4066 get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
4068 true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
4069 {
4071 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4072 segname)));
4074 /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
4075 (*endlogSegNo)++;
4076 }
4077 else
4078 {
4079 /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
4080 int rc;
4081
4083 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4084 segname)));
4085
4086#ifdef WIN32
4087
4088 /*
4089 * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
4090 * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
4091 * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
4092 * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
4093 * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
4094 *
4095 * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
4096 * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
4097 */
4098 snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
4099 if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
4100 {
4101 ereport(LOG,
4103 errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
4104 path)));
4105 return;
4106 }
4107 rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
4108#else
4109 rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
4110#endif
4111 if (rc != 0)
4112 {
4113 /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
4114 return;
4115 }
4117 }
4118
4120}
4121
4122/*
4123 * Verify whether pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
4124 * If the latter do not exist, recreate them.
4125 *
4126 * It is not the goal of this function to verify the contents of these
4127 * directories, but to help in cases where someone has performed a cluster
4128 * copy for PITR purposes but omitted pg_wal from the copy.
4129 *
4130 * We could also recreate pg_wal if it doesn't exist, but a deliberate
4131 * policy decision was made not to. It is fairly common for pg_wal to be
4132 * a symlink, and if that was the DBA's intent then automatically making a
4133 * plain directory would result in degraded performance with no notice.
4134 */
4135static void
4137{
4138 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4139 struct stat stat_buf;
4140
4141 /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
4142 if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
4143 !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4144 ereport(FATAL,
4146 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4147 XLOGDIR)));
4148
4149 /* Check for archive_status */
4150 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
4151 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4152 {
4153 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4154 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4155 ereport(FATAL,
4157 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4158 path)));
4159 }
4160 else
4161 {
4162 ereport(LOG,
4163 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4164 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4165 ereport(FATAL,
4167 errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4168 path)));
4169 }
4170
4171 /* Check for summaries */
4172 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
4173 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4174 {
4175 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4176 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4177 ereport(FATAL,
4178 (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4179 path)));
4180 }
4181 else
4182 {
4183 ereport(LOG,
4184 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4185 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4186 ereport(FATAL,
4187 (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4188 path)));
4189 }
4190}
4191
4192/*
4193 * Remove previous backup history files. This also retries creation of
4194 * .ready files for any backup history files for which XLogArchiveNotify
4195 * failed earlier.
4196 */
4197static void
4199{
4200 DIR *xldir;
4201 struct dirent *xlde;
4202 char path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
4203
4205
4206 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4207 {
4208 if (IsBackupHistoryFileName(xlde->d_name))
4209 {
4210 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
4211 {
4212 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
4213 xlde->d_name);
4214 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
4215 unlink(path);
4216 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlde->d_name);
4217 }
4218 }
4219 }
4220
4221 FreeDir(xldir);
4222}
4223
4224/*
4225 * I/O routines for pg_control
4226 *
4227 * *ControlFile is a buffer in shared memory that holds an image of the
4228 * contents of pg_control. WriteControlFile() initializes pg_control
4229 * given a preloaded buffer, ReadControlFile() loads the buffer from
4230 * the pg_control file (during postmaster or standalone-backend startup),
4231 * and UpdateControlFile() rewrites pg_control after we modify xlog state.
4232 * InitControlFile() fills the buffer with initial values.
4233 *
4234 * For simplicity, WriteControlFile() initializes the fields of pg_control
4235 * that are related to checking backend/database compatibility, and
4236 * ReadControlFile() verifies they are correct. We could split out the
4237 * I/O and compatibility-check functions, but there seems no need currently.
4238 */
4239
4240static void
4241InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
4242{
4244
4245 /*
4246 * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
4247 * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
4248 * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
4249 * of an actual stored password.
4250 */
4252 ereport(PANIC,
4254 errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
4255
4256 memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4257 /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
4258 ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
4262
4263 /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
4272 ControlFile->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
4273}
4274
4275static void
4277{
4278 int fd;
4279 char buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE]; /* need not be aligned */
4280
4281 /*
4282 * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
4283 */
4286
4289
4295
4298
4301
4302 ControlFile->float8ByVal = true; /* vestigial */
4303
4304 /*
4305 * Initialize the default 'char' signedness.
4306 *
4307 * The signedness of the char type is implementation-defined. For instance
4308 * on x86 architecture CPUs, the char data type is typically treated as
4309 * signed by default, whereas on aarch architecture CPUs, it is typically
4310 * treated as unsigned by default. In v17 or earlier, we accidentally let
4311 * C implementation signedness affect persistent data. This led to
4312 * inconsistent results when comparing char data across different
4313 * platforms.
4314 *
4315 * This flag can be used as a hint to ensure consistent behavior for
4316 * pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char' type on disk,
4317 * especially in cross-platform replication scenarios.
4318 *
4319 * Newly created database clusters unconditionally set the default char
4320 * signedness to true. pg_upgrade changes this flag for clusters that were
4321 * initialized on signedness=false platforms. As a result,
4322 * signedness=false setting will become rare over time. If we had known
4323 * about this problem during the last development cycle that forced initdb
4324 * (v8.3), we would have made all clusters signed or all clusters
4325 * unsigned. Making pg_upgrade the only source of signedness=false will
4326 * cause the population of database clusters to converge toward that
4327 * retrospective ideal.
4328 */
4330
4331 /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
4337
4338 /*
4339 * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
4340 * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData). This reduces the odds of
4341 * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control. We'll still fail when we
4342 * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
4343 * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
4344 */
4345 memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
4346 memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4347
4350 if (fd < 0)
4351 ereport(PANIC,
4353 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
4355
4356 errno = 0;
4359 {
4360 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
4361 if (errno == 0)
4362 errno = ENOSPC;
4363 ereport(PANIC,
4365 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
4367 }
4369
4371 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
4372 ereport(PANIC,
4374 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
4377
4378 if (close(fd) != 0)
4379 ereport(PANIC,
4381 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
4383}
4384
4385static void
4387{
4388 pg_crc32c crc;
4389 int fd;
4390 char wal_segsz_str[20];
4391 int r;
4392
4393 /*
4394 * Read data...
4395 */
4397 O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
4398 if (fd < 0)
4399 ereport(PANIC,
4401 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
4403
4405 r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4406 if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
4407 {
4408 if (r < 0)
4409 ereport(PANIC,
4411 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
4413 else
4414 ereport(PANIC,
4416 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
4417 XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
4418 }
4420
4421 close(fd);
4422
4423 /*
4424 * Check for expected pg_control format version. If this is wrong, the
4425 * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
4426 * of bytes. Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
4427 * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
4428 */
4429
4431 ereport(FATAL,
4433 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4434 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
4435 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
4438 errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering. It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4439
4441 ereport(FATAL,
4443 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4444 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
4445 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
4447 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4448
4449 /* Now check the CRC. */
4454 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
4455
4456 if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
4457 ereport(FATAL,
4459 errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
4460
4461 /*
4462 * Do compatibility checking immediately. If the database isn't
4463 * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
4464 * possibly do any damage.
4465 */
4467 ereport(FATAL,
4469 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4470 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4471 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4472 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4473 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", ControlFile->catalog_version_no,
4474 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
4475 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4477 ereport(FATAL,
4479 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4480 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4481 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4482 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4483 "MAXALIGN", ControlFile->maxAlign,
4484 "MAXALIGN", MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
4485 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4487 ereport(FATAL,
4489 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4490 errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
4491 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4492 if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
4493 ereport(FATAL,
4495 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4496 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4497 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4498 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4499 "BLCKSZ", ControlFile->blcksz,
4500 "BLCKSZ", BLCKSZ),
4501 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4503 ereport(FATAL,
4505 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4506 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4507 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4508 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4509 "RELSEG_SIZE", ControlFile->relseg_size,
4510 "RELSEG_SIZE", RELSEG_SIZE),
4511 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4513 ereport(FATAL,
4515 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4516 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4517 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4518 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4519 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment,
4520 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT),
4521 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4523 ereport(FATAL,
4525 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4526 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4527 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4528 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4529 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", ControlFile->xlog_blcksz,
4530 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", XLOG_BLCKSZ),
4531 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4533 ereport(FATAL,
4535 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4536 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4537 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4538 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4539 "NAMEDATALEN", ControlFile->nameDataLen,
4540 "NAMEDATALEN", NAMEDATALEN),
4541 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4543 ereport(FATAL,
4545 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4546 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4547 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4548 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4549 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", ControlFile->indexMaxKeys,
4550 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
4551 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4553 ereport(FATAL,
4555 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4556 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4557 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4558 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4559 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size,
4560 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
4561 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4563 ereport(FATAL,
4565 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4566 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4567 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4568 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4569 "LOBLKSIZE", ControlFile->loblksize,
4570 "LOBLKSIZE", (int) LOBLKSIZE),
4571 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4572
4573 Assert(ControlFile->float8ByVal); /* vestigial, not worth an error msg */
4574
4576
4579 errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
4580 "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
4583 errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
4584
4586 SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
4588
4589 /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
4592 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4593 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4594 "min_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4595
4598 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4599 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4600 "max_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4601
4605
4607
4608 /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
4609 SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
4611}
4612
4613/*
4614 * Utility wrapper to update the control file. Note that the control
4615 * file gets flushed.
4616 */
4617static void
4622
4623/*
4624 * Returns the unique system identifier from control file.
4625 */
4626uint64
4632
4633/*
4634 * Returns the random nonce from control file.
4635 */
4636char *
4642
4643/*
4644 * Are checksums enabled for data pages?
4645 */
4646bool
4648{
4650 return (ControlFile->data_checksum_version > 0);
4651}
4652
4653/*
4654 * Return true if the cluster was initialized on a platform where the
4655 * default signedness of char is "signed". This function exists for code
4656 * that deals with pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char'
4657 * type on disk (e.g., GIN and GiST indexes). See the comments in
4658 * WriteControlFile() for details.
4659 */
4660bool
4665
4666/*
4667 * Returns a fake LSN for unlogged relations.
4668 *
4669 * Each call generates an LSN that is greater than any previous value
4670 * returned. The current counter value is saved and restored across clean
4671 * shutdowns, but like unlogged relations, does not survive a crash. This can
4672 * be used in lieu of real LSN values returned by XLogInsert, if you need an
4673 * LSN-like increasing sequence of numbers without writing any WAL.
4674 */
4680
4681/*
4682 * Auto-tune the number of XLOG buffers.
4683 *
4684 * The preferred setting for wal_buffers is about 3% of shared_buffers, with
4685 * a maximum of one XLOG segment (there is little reason to think that more
4686 * is helpful, at least so long as we force an fsync when switching log files)
4687 * and a minimum of 8 blocks (which was the default value prior to PostgreSQL
4688 * 9.1, when auto-tuning was added).
4689 *
4690 * This should not be called until NBuffers has received its final value.
4691 */
4692static int
4694{
4695 int xbuffers;
4696
4697 xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
4700 if (xbuffers < 8)
4701 xbuffers = 8;
4702 return xbuffers;
4703}
4704
4705/*
4706 * GUC check_hook for wal_buffers
4707 */
4708bool
4710{
4711 /*
4712 * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
4713 */
4714 if (*newval == -1)
4715 {
4716 /*
4717 * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
4718 * be. We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
4719 */
4720 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4721 return true;
4722
4723 /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
4725 }
4726
4727 /*
4728 * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks. Prior to PostgreSQL
4729 * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
4730 * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
4731 * minimum. (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
4732 * helpful.)
4733 */
4734 if (*newval < 4)
4735 *newval = 4;
4736
4737 return true;
4738}
4739
4740/*
4741 * GUC check_hook for wal_consistency_checking
4742 */
4743bool
4745{
4746 char *rawstring;
4747 List *elemlist;
4748 ListCell *l;
4749 bool newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
4750
4751 /* Initialize the array */
4752 MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4753
4754 /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
4756
4757 /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
4759 {
4760 /* syntax error in list */
4761 GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
4764 return false;
4765 }
4766
4767 foreach(l, elemlist)
4768 {
4769 char *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
4770 int rmid;
4771
4772 /* Check for 'all'. */
4773 if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
4774 {
4775 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4776 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
4777 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4778 }
4779 else
4780 {
4781 /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
4782 bool found = false;
4783
4784 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4785 {
4786 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
4787 pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
4788 {
4789 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4790 found = true;
4791 break;
4792 }
4793 }
4794 if (!found)
4795 {
4796 /*
4797 * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
4798 * resource manager. Defer checking until
4799 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
4800 */
4802 {
4804 }
4805 else
4806 {
4807 GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
4810 return false;
4811 }
4812 }
4813 }
4814 }
4815
4818
4819 /* assign new value */
4820 *extra = guc_malloc(LOG, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4821 if (!*extra)
4822 return false;
4823 memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4824 return true;
4825}
4826
4827/*
4828 * GUC assign_hook for wal_consistency_checking
4829 */
4830void
4832{
4833 /*
4834 * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
4835 * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
4836 * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
4837 * assignment.
4838 *
4839 * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
4840 * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
4841 * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
4842 * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
4843 * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
4844 * module is loaded anyway.
4845 */
4847}
4848
4849/*
4850 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking: run after loading custom resource managers
4851 *
4852 * If any unknown resource managers were specified in the
4853 * wal_consistency_checking GUC, processing was deferred. Now that
4854 * shared_preload_libraries have been loaded, process wal_consistency_checking
4855 * again.
4856 */
4857void
4859{
4861
4863 {
4864 struct config_generic *guc;
4865
4866 guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
4867
4869
4870 set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
4872 guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
4873 GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
4874
4875 /* checking should not be deferred again */
4877 }
4878}
4879
4880/*
4881 * GUC show_hook for archive_command
4882 */
4883const char *
4885{
4886 if (XLogArchivingActive())
4887 return XLogArchiveCommand;
4888 else
4889 return "(disabled)";
4890}
4891
4892/*
4893 * GUC show_hook for in_hot_standby
4894 */
4895const char *
4897{
4898 /*
4899 * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
4900 * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query. The underlying
4901 * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
4902 * to the client.
4903 */
4904 return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
4905}
4906
4907/*
4908 * GUC show_hook for effective_wal_level
4909 */
4910const char *
4912{
4914 return "minimal";
4915
4916 /*
4917 * During recovery, effective_wal_level reflects the primary's
4918 * configuration rather than the local wal_level value.
4919 */
4920 if (RecoveryInProgress())
4921 return IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled() ? "logical" : "replica";
4922
4923 return XLogLogicalInfoActive() ? "logical" : "replica";
4924}
4925
4926/*
4927 * Read the control file, set respective GUCs.
4928 *
4929 * This is to be called during startup, including a crash recovery cycle,
4930 * unless in bootstrap mode, where no control file yet exists. As there's no
4931 * usable shared memory yet (its sizing can depend on the contents of the
4932 * control file!), first store the contents in local memory. XLOGShmemInit()
4933 * will then copy it to shared memory later.
4934 *
4935 * reset just controls whether previous contents are to be expected (in the
4936 * reset case, there's a dangling pointer into old shared memory), or not.
4937 */
4938void
4945
4946/*
4947 * Get the wal_level from the control file. For a standby, this value should be
4948 * considered as its active wal_level, because it may be different from what
4949 * was originally configured on standby.
4950 */
4953{
4954 return ControlFile->wal_level;
4955}
4956
4957/*
4958 * Initialization of shared memory for XLOG
4959 */
4960Size
4962{
4963 Size size;
4964
4965 /*
4966 * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
4967 * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
4968 * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
4969 * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
4970 *
4971 * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
4972 * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
4973 * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
4974 * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
4975 */
4976 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4977 {
4978 char buf[32];
4979
4980 snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
4981 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4983 if (XLOGbuffers == -1) /* failed to apply it? */
4984 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4986 }
4987 Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
4988
4989 /* XLogCtl */
4990 size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
4991
4992 /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
4993 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
4994 /* xlblocks array */
4995 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
4996 /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
4997 size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
4998 /* and the buffers themselves */
4999 size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
5000
5001 /*
5002 * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
5003 * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores. This lets us use this
5004 * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
5005 */
5006
5007 return size;
5008}
5009
5010void
5012{
5013 bool foundCFile,
5014 foundXLog;
5015 char *allocptr;
5016 int i;
5018
5019#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
5020
5021 /*
5022 * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
5023 * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
5024 * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
5025 */
5026 if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
5027 {
5029 "WAL Debug",
5032 }
5033#endif
5034
5035
5036 XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
5037 ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
5038
5041 ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
5042
5043 if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
5044 {
5045 /* both should be present or neither */
5047
5048 /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
5050
5051 if (localControlFile)
5053 return;
5054 }
5055 memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
5056
5057 /*
5058 * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
5059 * contents into shared memory.
5060 */
5061 if (localControlFile)
5062 {
5065 }
5066
5067 /*
5068 * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
5069 * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
5070 * needed here.
5071 */
5072 allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
5075
5076 for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
5077 {
5079 }
5080
5081 /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
5082 allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
5087
5088 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
5089 {
5093 }
5094
5095 /*
5096 * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
5097 * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
5098 * required for O_DIRECT.
5099 */
5103
5104 /*
5105 * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
5106 * in additional info.)
5107 */
5111 XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
5112
5119}
5120
5121/*
5122 * This func must be called ONCE on system install. It creates pg_control
5123 * and the initial XLOG segment.
5124 */
5125void
5126BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
5127{
5128 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5129 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
5130 XLogPageHeader page;
5132 XLogRecord *record;
5133 char *recptr;
5134 uint64 sysidentifier;
5135 struct timeval tv;
5136 pg_crc32c crc;
5137
5138 /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
5140
5141 /*
5142 * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
5143 * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
5144 * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get. (Think not to
5145 * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
5146 * to seed it other than the system clock value...) The upper half of the
5147 * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
5148 * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
5149 * PID for a little extra uniqueness. A person knowing this encoding can
5150 * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
5151 * perhaps be useful sometimes.
5152 */
5153 gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
5154 sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
5155 sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
5156 sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
5157
5158 memset(&buffer, 0, sizeof buffer);
5159 page = (XLogPageHeader) &buffer;
5160
5161 /*
5162 * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
5163 *
5164 * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
5165 * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
5166 * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
5167 */
5171 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
5173 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
5174 checkPoint.nextXid =
5176 checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
5177 checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5178 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 1;
5180 checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
5181 checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5182 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
5185 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
5187
5188 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5189 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5191 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5192 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5193 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5194 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5196
5197 /* Set up the XLOG page header */
5198 page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
5199 page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
5203 longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
5204 longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
5205 longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
5206
5207 /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
5208 recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
5209 record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
5210 record->xl_prev = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
5211 record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
5212 record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
5214 record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
5216 /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
5217 *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
5218 *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
5219 memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
5220 recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
5221 Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
5222
5224 COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
5225 COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
5226 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
5227 record->xl_crc = crc;
5228
5229 /* Create first XLOG segment file */
5232
5233 /*
5234 * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
5235 * close the file again in a moment.
5236 */
5237
5238 /* Write the first page with the initial record */
5239 errno = 0;
5241 if (write(openLogFile, &buffer, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
5242 {
5243 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
5244 if (errno == 0)
5245 errno = ENOSPC;
5246 ereport(PANIC,
5248 errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5249 }
5251
5253 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
5254 ereport(PANIC,
5256 errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5258
5259 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
5260 ereport(PANIC,
5262 errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5263
5264 openLogFile = -1;
5265
5266 /* Now create pg_control */
5267 InitControlFile(sysidentifier, data_checksum_version);
5268 ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
5269 ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
5270 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
5271
5272 /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
5274
5275 /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
5276 BootStrapCLOG();
5280
5281 /*
5282 * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
5283 * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
5284 */
5286}
5287
5288static char *
5290{
5292 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
5294
5295 return buf;
5296}
5297
5298/*
5299 * Initialize the first WAL segment on new timeline.
5300 */
5301static void
5303{
5304 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5307
5308 /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
5309 Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
5310
5311 /*
5312 * Update min recovery point one last time.
5313 */
5315
5316 /*
5317 * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
5318 * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
5319 * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
5320 * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
5321 */
5324
5325 /*
5326 * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
5327 * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
5328 * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
5329 * on the new timeline.
5330 */
5332 {
5333 /*
5334 * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
5335 *
5336 * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
5337 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
5338 * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
5339 */
5342 }
5343 else
5344 {
5345 /*
5346 * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
5347 * segment on the new timeline.
5348 */
5349 int fd;
5350
5352
5353 if (close(fd) != 0)
5354 {
5355 int save_errno = errno;
5356
5358 errno = save_errno;
5359 ereport(ERROR,
5361 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
5362 }
5363 }
5364
5365 /*
5366 * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
5367 * for the new segment.
5368 */
5371}
5372
5373/*
5374 * Perform cleanup actions at the conclusion of archive recovery.
5375 */
5376static void
5379{
5380 /*
5381 * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
5382 */
5385 "recovery_end_command",
5386 true,
5388
5389 /*
5390 * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
5391 *
5392 * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
5393 * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
5394 * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
5395 * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
5396 */
5398
5399 /*
5400 * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
5401 * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
5402 * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
5403 * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
5404 * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
5405 * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
5406 * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
5407 * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
5408 * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
5409 * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
5410 * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
5411 * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
5412 * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
5413 * caused such problems).
5414 *
5415 * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
5416 * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
5417 * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
5418 * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
5419 * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
5420 *
5421 * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
5422 * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
5423 * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
5424 * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
5425 */
5428 {
5429 char origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5431
5434
5436 {
5437 char origpath[MAXPGPATH];
5439 char partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
5440
5441 /*
5442 * If we're summarizing WAL, we can't rename the partial file
5443 * until the summarizer finishes with it, else it will fail.
5444 */
5445 if (summarize_wal)
5447
5449 snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
5450 snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
5451
5452 /*
5453 * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
5454 * file.
5455 */
5457
5460 }
5461 }
5462}
5463
5464/*
5465 * Check to see if required parameters are set high enough on this server
5466 * for various aspects of recovery operation.
5467 *
5468 * Note that all the parameters which this function tests need to be
5469 * listed in Administrator's Overview section in high-availability.sgml.
5470 * If you change them, don't forget to update the list.
5471 */
5472static void
5474{
5475 /*
5476 * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
5477 * wal_level.
5478 */
5480 {
5481 ereport(FATAL,
5483 errmsg("WAL was generated with \"wal_level=minimal\", cannot continue recovering"),
5484 errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set \"wal_level=minimal\" on the server."),
5485 errhint("Use a backup taken after setting \"wal_level\" to higher than \"minimal\".")));
5486 }
5487
5488 /*
5489 * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
5490 * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
5491 */
5493 {
5494 /* We ignore autovacuum_worker_slots when we make this test. */
5495 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
5498 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
5501 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
5504 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
5507 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
5510 }
5511}
5512
5513/*
5514 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend startup
5515 */
5516void
5518{
5520 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5521 bool wasShutdown;
5522 bool didCrash;
5523 bool haveTblspcMap;
5524 bool haveBackupLabel;
5533 bool promoted = false;
5534 char timebuf[128];
5535
5536 /*
5537 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
5538 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
5539 */
5544
5545 /*
5546 * Check that contents look valid.
5547 */
5549 ereport(FATAL,
5551 errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
5552
5553 switch (ControlFile->state)
5554 {
5555 case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
5556
5557 /*
5558 * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
5559 * mode
5560 */
5562 (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
5564 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5565 break;
5566
5568 ereport(LOG,
5569 (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
5571 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5572 break;
5573
5574 case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
5575 ereport(LOG,
5576 (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5578 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5579 break;
5580
5582 ereport(LOG,
5583 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
5585 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5586 errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
5587 " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
5588 break;
5589
5591 ereport(LOG,
5592 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
5594 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5595 errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
5596 " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
5597 break;
5598
5599 case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
5600 ereport(LOG,
5601 (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5603 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5604 break;
5605
5606 default:
5607 ereport(FATAL,
5609 errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
5610 }
5611
5612 /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
5613#ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
5615 pg_usleep(60000000L);
5616#endif
5617
5618 /*
5619 * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
5620 * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
5621 * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
5622 */
5624
5625 /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
5629
5630 /*----------
5631 * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
5632 *
5633 * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
5634 * used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
5635 * bloat this path. This is done first as there is no point to sync
5636 * this temporary data.
5637 *
5638 * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
5639 * which we had not actually fsync'd yet. Therefore, a power failure in
5640 * the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
5641 * though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
5642 * persisted. To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
5643 */
5646 {
5649 didCrash = true;
5650 }
5651 else
5652 didCrash = false;
5653
5654 /*
5655 * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
5656 *
5657 * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
5658 * any. It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
5659 * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
5660 * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
5661 */
5664 checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
5665
5666 /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
5667 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5668 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5670 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5671 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5672 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5673 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5675 checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
5676
5677 /*
5678 * Clear out any old relcache cache files. This is *necessary* if we do
5679 * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
5680 * being out of sync with database reality. In theory we could leave them
5681 * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
5682 * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
5683 * first backend startup. These files needs to be removed from all
5684 * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
5685 * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
5686 * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
5687 * symlinks.
5688 */
5690
5691 /*
5692 * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
5693 * required resources.
5694 */
5696
5697 /*
5698 * Startup the logical decoding status with the last status stored in the
5699 * checkpoint record.
5700 */
5702
5703 /*
5704 * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
5705 * during crash recovery.
5706 */
5708
5709 /*
5710 * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
5711 * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
5712 */
5713 StartupCLOG();
5714
5715 /*
5716 * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
5717 * truncations.
5718 */
5720
5721 /*
5722 * Ditto for commit timestamps. Activate the facility if the setting is
5723 * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
5724 * timestamps done when the setting was disabled. This facility can be
5725 * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
5726 */
5729
5730 /*
5731 * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
5732 */
5734
5735 /*
5736 * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
5737 * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
5738 * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
5739 */
5743 else
5746
5747 /*
5748 * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
5749 * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
5750 * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
5751 * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
5752 * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
5753 * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
5754 * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
5755 * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
5756 * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
5757 * and regret later.
5758 */
5760
5761 /*
5762 * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
5763 * be able to work on entries generated by redo. Doing a scan before
5764 * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
5765 * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
5766 * replay. This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
5767 * of the on-disk two-phase data.
5768 */
5770
5771 /*
5772 * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
5773 * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
5774 * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
5775 *
5776 * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
5777 * already been restored from disk.
5778 *
5779 * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
5780 * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
5781 */
5782 if (didCrash)
5784 else
5786
5788
5791
5792 /* REDO */
5793 if (InRecovery)
5794 {
5795 /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
5799 else
5802
5803 /*
5804 * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
5805 * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
5806 * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
5807 * backup history file.
5808 *
5809 * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
5810 */
5812
5813 /*
5814 * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
5815 * has now been propagated into pg_control. We must get rid of the
5816 * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
5817 * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
5818 * to the backup start point. It seems prudent though to just rename
5819 * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
5820 */
5821 if (haveBackupLabel)
5822 {
5825 }
5826
5827 /*
5828 * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
5829 * symlinks have been created. We must get rid of the map file so
5830 * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
5831 * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
5832 * rather than delete it completely.
5833 */
5834 if (haveTblspcMap)
5835 {
5838 }
5839
5840 /*
5841 * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint. When doing crash
5842 * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL. Particularly, in
5843 * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
5844 * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint. However,
5845 * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
5846 * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
5847 * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
5848 * references when checking for data consistency.
5849 */
5851 {
5854 }
5855 else
5856 {
5859 }
5860
5861 /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
5863
5864 /*
5865 * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
5866 * reset. This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
5867 * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
5868 * garbage is left over from before.
5869 */
5871
5872 /*
5873 * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
5874 * behind by crashed backends.
5875 */
5877
5878 /*
5879 * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
5880 * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
5881 * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
5882 * running-xacts WAL record.
5883 */
5885 {
5886 TransactionId *xids;
5887 int nxids;
5888
5890 (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
5891
5893
5894 if (wasShutdown)
5896 else
5897 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
5899
5900 /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
5902
5903 /*
5904 * Startup subtrans only. CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
5905 * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
5906 * during recovery and need not be started yet.
5907 */
5909
5910 /*
5911 * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
5912 * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
5913 * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
5914 * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
5915 */
5916 if (wasShutdown)
5917 {
5919 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
5920
5921 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
5923
5924 /*
5925 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
5926 * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
5927 * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
5928 * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
5929 */
5930 running.xcnt = nxids;
5931 running.subxcnt = 0;
5933 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5935 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5936 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
5937 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
5938 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
5939 running.xids = xids;
5940
5942 }
5943 }
5944
5945 /*
5946 * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
5947 */
5949 performedWalRecovery = true;
5950 }
5951 else
5952 performedWalRecovery = false;
5953
5954 /*
5955 * Finish WAL recovery.
5956 */
5958 EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
5959 EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
5960 abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
5961 missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
5962
5963 /*
5964 * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
5965 * up.
5966 */
5967 set_ps_display("");
5968
5969 /*
5970 * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
5971 * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
5972 * the point where the database is consistent. For regular online
5973 * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
5974 * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
5975 * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
5976 * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
5977 * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica). For
5978 * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
5979 * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
5980 * to false.
5981 *
5982 * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
5983 * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
5984 * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
5985 * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
5986 */
5987 if (InRecovery &&
5990 {
5991 /*
5992 * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
5993 * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
5994 * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
5995 * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
5996 */
5998 {
6000 ereport(FATAL,
6002 errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
6003 errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
6004 else
6005 ereport(FATAL,
6007 errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
6008 }
6009 }
6010
6011 /*
6012 * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
6013 * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
6014 * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
6015 * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
6016 * end-of-recovery steps fail.
6017 */
6018 if (InRecovery)
6020
6021 /*
6022 * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
6023 * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
6024 * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
6025 */
6027
6028 /*
6029 * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
6030 * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
6031 */
6033
6034 /*
6035 * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
6036 *
6037 * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID. This handles a
6038 * couple of issues. If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
6039 * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
6040 * it a unique new ID. Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
6041 * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
6042 * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
6043 * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that. We can dodge the
6044 * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
6045 *
6046 * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
6047 */
6048 newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
6050 {
6052 ereport(LOG,
6053 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
6054
6055 /*
6056 * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment. (Note that we also
6057 * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
6058 * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
6059 */
6061
6062 /*
6063 * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
6064 * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
6065 */
6066 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
6068
6069 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
6071
6072 /*
6073 * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
6074 * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
6075 * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
6076 * servers. If we crash before actually switching to the new
6077 * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
6078 * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
6079 * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
6080 * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
6081 */
6083 EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6084
6085 ereport(LOG,
6086 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
6087 }
6088
6089 /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
6094
6095 /*
6096 * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
6097 * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
6098 * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
6099 * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
6100 */
6102 {
6103 /*
6104 * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
6105 * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
6106 * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
6107 * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
6108 * disregard.
6109 */
6110 Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
6113 }
6114
6115 /*
6116 * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
6117 * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
6118 * previous incarnation.
6119 */
6120 Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
6122 Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
6123
6124 /*
6125 * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
6126 * record spans, not the one it starts in. The last block is indeed the
6127 * one we want to use.
6128 */
6129 if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
6130 {
6131 char *page;
6132 int len;
6133 int firstIdx;
6134
6136 len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
6138
6139 /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
6140 page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
6141 memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
6142 memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
6143
6146 }
6147 else
6148 {
6149 /*
6150 * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
6151 * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
6152 * buffer.
6153 */
6155 }
6156
6157 /*
6158 * Update local and shared status. This is OK to do without any locks
6159 * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
6160 */
6167
6168 /*
6169 * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
6170 */
6172
6173 /*
6174 * Okay, we're officially UP.
6175 */
6176 InRecovery = false;
6177
6178 /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
6181
6182 /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
6187
6188 /*
6189 * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby. (commit
6190 * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
6191 */
6194
6195 /*
6196 * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
6197 */
6198 TrimCLOG();
6199 TrimMultiXact();
6200
6201 /*
6202 * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions. This needs to
6203 * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
6204 * it may be possible that we have to recover some transactions from it.
6205 */
6207
6208 /* Shut down xlogreader */
6210
6211 /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
6213
6214 /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
6216 {
6219 }
6220
6221 /*
6222 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
6223 * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
6224 * record is written.
6225 */
6226 Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
6228
6229 /*
6230 * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
6231 */
6234
6235 /*
6236 * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
6237 * backends to write WAL.
6238 */
6240
6241 /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
6244
6245 /*
6246 * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
6247 * commit timestamp.
6248 */
6250
6251 /*
6252 * Update logical decoding status in shared memory and write an
6253 * XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE, if necessary.
6254 */
6256
6257 /* Clean up EndOfWalRecoveryInfo data to appease Valgrind leak checking */
6258 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage)
6259 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage);
6260 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6262
6263 /*
6264 * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
6265 *
6266 * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
6267 * consequence. SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
6268 * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
6269 * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
6270 * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
6271 * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
6272 * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
6273 *
6274 * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
6275 * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
6276 * updates to shared memory.
6277 */
6280
6284
6287
6288 /*
6289 * Wake up the checkpointer process as there might be a request to disable
6290 * logical decoding by concurrent slot drop.
6291 */
6293
6294 /*
6295 * Wake up all waiters. They need to report an error that recovery was
6296 * ended before reaching the target LSN.
6297 */
6301
6302 /*
6303 * Shutdown the recovery environment. This must occur after
6304 * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
6305 * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
6306 * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
6307 * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage. This is
6308 * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
6309 * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
6310 */
6313
6314 /*
6315 * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
6316 * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
6317 */
6318 WalSndWakeup(true, true);
6319
6320 /*
6321 * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
6322 * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
6323 * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
6324 * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
6325 */
6326 if (promoted)
6328}
6329
6330/*
6331 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we switch from crash
6332 * recovery to archive recovery mode. Updates the control file accordingly.
6333 */
6334void
6336{
6337 /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
6340 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6341 {
6342 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6343 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
6344 }
6345 /* update local copy */
6348
6349 /*
6350 * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
6351 * this point.
6352 */
6354
6356
6357 /*
6358 * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
6359 * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
6360 */
6364
6366}
6367
6368/*
6369 * Callback from PerformWalRecovery(), called when we reach the end of backup.
6370 * Updates the control file accordingly.
6371 */
6372void
6374{
6375 /*
6376 * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
6377 * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
6378 * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery). Reset
6379 * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
6380 * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
6381 * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
6382 */
6384
6385 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6386 {
6387 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6389 }
6390
6395
6397}
6398
6399/*
6400 * Perform whatever XLOG actions are necessary at end of REDO.
6401 *
6402 * The goal here is to make sure that we'll be able to recover properly if
6403 * we crash again. If we choose to write a checkpoint, we'll write a shutdown
6404 * checkpoint rather than an on-line one. This is not particularly critical,
6405 * but since we may be assigning a new TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows
6406 * us to have the rule that TLI only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which
6407 * allows some extra error checking in xlog_redo.
6408 */
6409static bool
6411{
6412 bool promoted = false;
6413
6414 /*
6415 * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
6416 *
6417 * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
6418 * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
6419 * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
6420 * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
6421 * checking in xlog_redo.
6422 *
6423 * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
6424 * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
6425 * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
6426 */
6429 {
6430 promoted = true;
6431
6432 /*
6433 * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
6434 * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
6435 * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
6436 * could continue to be for minutes after this. That sounds strange,
6437 * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
6438 * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
6439 * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
6440 */
6442 }
6443 else
6444 {
6448 }
6449
6450 return promoted;
6451}
6452
6453/*
6454 * Is the system still in recovery?
6455 *
6456 * Unlike testing InRecovery, this works in any process that's connected to
6457 * shared memory.
6458 */
6459bool
6461{
6462 /*
6463 * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
6464 * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
6465 * shared variable has once been seen false.
6466 */
6468 return false;
6469 else
6470 {
6471 /*
6472 * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
6473 * shared variable.
6474 */
6475 volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
6476
6477 LocalRecoveryInProgress = (xlogctl->SharedRecoveryState != RECOVERY_STATE_DONE);
6478
6479 /*
6480 * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
6481 * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
6482 * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
6483 */
6484
6486 }
6487}
6488
6489/*
6490 * Returns current recovery state from shared memory.
6491 *
6492 * This returned state is kept consistent with the contents of the control
6493 * file. See details about the possible values of RecoveryState in xlog.h.
6494 */
6497{
6498 RecoveryState retval;
6499
6501 retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
6503
6504 return retval;
6505}
6506
6507/*
6508 * Is this process allowed to insert new WAL records?
6509 *
6510 * Ordinarily this is essentially equivalent to !RecoveryInProgress().
6511 * But we also have provisions for forcing the result "true" or "false"
6512 * within specific processes regardless of the global state.
6513 */
6514bool
6516{
6517 /*
6518 * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
6519 * return it. This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
6520 * done.
6521 */
6522 if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
6523 return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
6524
6525 /*
6526 * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
6527 */
6528 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6529 return false;
6530
6531 /*
6532 * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
6533 * no need to keep checking.
6534 */
6536 return true;
6537}
6538
6539/*
6540 * Make XLogInsertAllowed() return true in the current process only.
6541 *
6542 * Note: it is allowed to switch LocalXLogInsertAllowed back to -1 later,
6543 * and even call LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed() again after that.
6544 *
6545 * Returns the previous value of LocalXLogInsertAllowed.
6546 */
6547static int
6549{
6551
6553
6554 return oldXLogAllowed;
6555}
6556
6557/*
6558 * Return the current Redo pointer from shared memory.
6559 *
6560 * As a side-effect, the local RedoRecPtr copy is updated.
6561 */
6564{
6565 XLogRecPtr ptr;
6566
6567 /*
6568 * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
6569 * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
6570 * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
6571 * the lock.
6572 */
6574 ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
6576
6577 if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
6578 RedoRecPtr = ptr;
6579
6580 return RedoRecPtr;
6581}
6582
6583/*
6584 * Return information needed to decide whether a modified block needs a
6585 * full-page image to be included in the WAL record.
6586 *
6587 * The returned values are cached copies from backend-private memory, and
6588 * possibly out-of-date or, indeed, uninitialized, in which case they will
6589 * be InvalidXLogRecPtr and false, respectively. XLogInsertRecord will
6590 * re-check them against up-to-date values, while holding the WAL insert lock.
6591 */
6592void
6598
6599/*
6600 * GetInsertRecPtr -- Returns the current insert position.
6601 *
6602 * NOTE: The value *actually* returned is the position of the last full
6603 * xlog page. It lags behind the real insert position by at most 1 page.
6604 * For that, we don't need to scan through WAL insertion locks, and an
6605 * approximation is enough for the current usage of this function.
6606 */
6609{
6611
6615
6616 return recptr;
6617}
6618
6619/*
6620 * GetFlushRecPtr -- Returns the current flush position, ie, the last WAL
6621 * position known to be fsync'd to disk. This should only be used on a
6622 * system that is known not to be in recovery.
6623 */
6626{
6628
6630
6631 /*
6632 * If we're writing and flushing WAL, the time line can't be changing, so
6633 * no lock is required.
6634 */
6635 if (insertTLI)
6637
6638 return LogwrtResult.Flush;
6639}
6640
6641/*
6642 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine -- Returns the current timeline of a system that
6643 * is not in recovery.
6644 */
6647{
6649
6650 /* Since the value can't be changing, no lock is required. */
6651 return XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
6652}
6653
6654/*
6655 * GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet -- If the system is not in recovery, returns
6656 * the WAL insertion timeline; else, returns 0. Wherever possible, use
6657 * GetWALInsertionTimeLine() instead, since it's cheaper. Note that this
6658 * function decides recovery has ended as soon as the insert TLI is set, which
6659 * happens before we set XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE.
6660 */
6672
6673/*
6674 * GetLastImportantRecPtr -- Returns the LSN of the last important record
6675 * inserted. All records not explicitly marked as unimportant are considered
6676 * important.
6677 *
6678 * The LSN is determined by computing the maximum of
6679 * WALInsertLocks[i].lastImportantAt.
6680 */
6683{
6685 int i;
6686
6687 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
6688 {
6690
6691 /*
6692 * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
6693 * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
6694 * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
6695 */
6698 LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
6699
6700 if (res < last_important)
6701 res = last_important;
6702 }
6703
6704 return res;
6705}
6706
6707/*
6708 * Get the time and LSN of the last xlog segment switch
6709 */
6712{
6713 pg_time_t result;
6714
6715 /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
6717 result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
6720
6721 return result;
6722}
6723
6724/*
6725 * This must be called ONCE during postmaster or standalone-backend shutdown
6726 */
6727void
6729{
6730 /*
6731 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
6732 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
6733 */
6738
6739 /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
6741 (errmsg("shutting down")));
6742
6743 /*
6744 * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
6745 */
6747
6748 /*
6749 * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state. This prevents commands
6750 * from writing new WAL.
6751 */
6753
6754 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6756 else
6757 {
6758 /*
6759 * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
6760 * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
6761 * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
6762 * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
6763 */
6764 if (XLogArchivingActive())
6765 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
6766
6768 }
6769}
6770
6771/*
6772 * Log start of a checkpoint.
6773 */
6774static void
6776{
6777 if (restartpoint)
6778 ereport(LOG,
6779 /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
6780 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
6781 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
6782 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
6783 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
6784 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
6785 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
6786 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
6787 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
6788 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "")));
6789 else
6790 ereport(LOG,
6791 /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
6792 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
6793 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
6794 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
6795 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
6796 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
6797 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
6798 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
6799 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
6800 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "")));
6801}
6802
6803/*
6804 * Log end of a checkpoint.
6805 */
6806static void
6808{
6809 long write_msecs,
6810 sync_msecs,
6815
6817
6820
6823
6824 /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
6827
6828 /*
6829 * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for. Only
6830 * continue if a log message is to be written.
6831 */
6832 if (!log_checkpoints)
6833 return;
6834
6837
6838 /*
6839 * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
6840 * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
6841 */
6843
6848 average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
6849
6850 /*
6851 * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
6852 * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
6853 * this moment.
6854 */
6855 if (restartpoint)
6856 ereport(LOG,
6857 (errmsg("restartpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6858 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6859 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6860 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6861 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6862 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6869 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6870 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6871 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6873 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6874 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6875 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6876 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6879 else
6880 ereport(LOG,
6881 (errmsg("checkpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6882 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6883 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6884 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6885 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6886 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6893 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6894 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6895 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6897 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6898 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6899 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6900 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6903}
6904
6905/*
6906 * Update the estimate of distance between checkpoints.
6907 *
6908 * The estimate is used to calculate the number of WAL segments to keep
6909 * preallocated, see XLOGfileslop().
6910 */
6911static void
6913{
6914 /*
6915 * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
6916 * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
6917 * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
6918 * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
6919 * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
6920 * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
6921 * more.
6922 *
6923 * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
6924 * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
6925 *
6926 * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
6927 * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
6928 * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
6929 * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
6930 * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
6931 * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
6932 * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
6933 * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
6934 * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
6935 */
6936 PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
6937 if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
6939 else
6941 (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
6942}
6943
6944/*
6945 * Update the ps display for a process running a checkpoint. Note that
6946 * this routine should not do any allocations so as it can be called
6947 * from a critical section.
6948 */
6949static void
6951{
6952 /*
6953 * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
6954 * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints. Updating the ps display is
6955 * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
6956 * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
6957 * process.
6958 */
6960 return;
6961
6962 if (reset)
6963 set_ps_display("");
6964 else
6965 {
6966 char activitymsg[128];
6967
6968 snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
6969 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
6970 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
6971 restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
6973 }
6974}
6975
6976
6977/*
6978 * Perform a checkpoint --- either during shutdown, or on-the-fly
6979 *
6980 * flags is a bitwise OR of the following:
6981 * CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN: checkpoint is for database shutdown.
6982 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY: checkpoint is for end of WAL recovery.
6983 * CHECKPOINT_FAST: finish the checkpoint ASAP, ignoring
6984 * checkpoint_completion_target parameter.
6985 * CHECKPOINT_FORCE: force a checkpoint even if no XLOG activity has occurred
6986 * since the last one (implied by CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN or
6987 * CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY).
6988 * CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED: also flush buffers of unlogged tables.
6989 *
6990 * Note: flags contains other bits, of interest here only for logging purposes.
6991 * In particular note that this routine is synchronous and does not pay
6992 * attention to CHECKPOINT_WAIT.
6993 *
6994 * If !shutdown then we are writing an online checkpoint. An XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
6995 * record is inserted into WAL at the logical location of the checkpoint, before
6996 * flushing anything to disk, and when the checkpoint is eventually completed,
6997 * and it is from this point that WAL replay will begin in the case of a recovery
6998 * from this checkpoint. Once everything is written to disk, an
6999 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE record is written to complete the checkpoint, and
7000 * points back to the earlier XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO record. This mechanism allows
7001 * other write-ahead log records to be written while the checkpoint is in
7002 * progress, but we must be very careful about order of operations. This function
7003 * may take many minutes to execute on a busy system.
7004 *
7005 * On the other hand, when shutdown is true, concurrent insertion into the
7006 * write-ahead log is impossible, so there is no need for two separate records.
7007 * In this case, we only insert an XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record, and it's
7008 * both the record marking the completion of the checkpoint and the location
7009 * from which WAL replay would begin if needed.
7010 *
7011 * Returns true if a new checkpoint was performed, or false if it was skipped
7012 * because the system was idle.
7013 */
7014bool
7016{
7017 bool shutdown;
7018 CheckPoint checkPoint;
7022 uint32 freespace;
7026 int nvxids;
7027 int oldXLogAllowed = 0;
7028
7029 /*
7030 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
7031 * issued at a different time.
7032 */
7034 shutdown = true;
7035 else
7036 shutdown = false;
7037
7038 /* sanity check */
7039 if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
7040 elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
7041
7042 /*
7043 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7044 *
7045 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7046 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7047 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7048 */
7051
7052 /*
7053 * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
7054 * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer. Note that
7055 * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
7056 * checkpoint is needed.
7057 */
7059
7060 /* Run these points outside the critical section. */
7061 INJECTION_POINT("create-checkpoint-initial", NULL);
7062 INJECTION_POINT_LOAD("create-checkpoint-run");
7063
7064 /*
7065 * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
7066 */
7068
7069 if (shutdown)
7070 {
7075 }
7076
7077 /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
7078 MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
7079 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
7080
7081 /*
7082 * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
7083 * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
7084 * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
7085 */
7087 checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(false, true);
7088 else
7090
7091 /*
7092 * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
7093 * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
7094 */
7096
7097 /*
7098 * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
7099 * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it. The idea here is to
7100 * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
7101 */
7103 CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
7104 {
7106 {
7109 (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
7110 return false;
7111 }
7112 }
7113
7114 /*
7115 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
7116 * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
7117 * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
7118 */
7119 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7121
7123 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7125 else
7126 checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
7127
7128 /*
7129 * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
7130 */
7132
7133 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
7134 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
7135
7136 if (shutdown)
7137 {
7139
7140 /*
7141 * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
7142 *
7143 * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
7144 * WAL insertion.
7145 */
7146 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
7147 if (freespace == 0)
7148 {
7151 else
7153 }
7154 checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
7155
7156 /*
7157 * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
7158 * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
7159 *
7160 * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
7161 * left pointing past where it really needs to point. This is okay;
7162 * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
7163 * that it didn't really need to. We can't postpone advancing
7164 * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
7165 * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
7166 * the checkpoint.
7167 */
7168 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7169 }
7170
7171 /*
7172 * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
7173 * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
7174 */
7176
7177 /*
7178 * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
7179 * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7180 * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
7181 * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
7182 * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
7183 * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
7184 * mark the redo point.
7185 */
7186 if (!shutdown)
7187 {
7188 /* Include WAL level in record for WAL summarizer's benefit. */
7192
7193 /*
7194 * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
7195 * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
7196 * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
7197 * checkpoint is complete.
7198 */
7199 checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
7200 }
7201
7202 /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
7204 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7206
7207 /*
7208 * If enabled, log checkpoint start. We postpone this until now so as not
7209 * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
7210 */
7211 if (log_checkpoints)
7212 LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
7213
7214 INJECTION_POINT_CACHED("create-checkpoint-run", NULL);
7215
7216 /* Update the process title */
7217 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
7218
7220
7221 /*
7222 * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
7223 *
7224 * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
7225 * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
7226 * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
7227 * there.
7228 */
7230 checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
7231 checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
7234
7239
7241 checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
7242 if (!shutdown)
7243 checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
7245
7247
7249 &checkPoint.nextMulti,
7250 &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
7251 &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
7252 &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
7253
7254 /*
7255 * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
7256 * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
7257 *
7258 * This I/O could fail for various reasons. If so, we will fail to
7259 * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
7260 * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
7261 */
7263
7264 /*
7265 * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
7266 * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
7267 * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
7268 * performing those groups of actions.
7269 *
7270 * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
7271 * that are currently in commit critical sections. If an xact inserted
7272 * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
7273 * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
7274 * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact. So
7275 * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
7276 * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
7277 *
7278 * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
7279 * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
7280 * to wait for. But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
7281 * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
7282 * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
7283 * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
7284 * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
7285 * minimizing lock contention.)
7286 *
7287 * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
7288 * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
7289 * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
7290 * clog and we will correctly flush the update below. So we cannot miss
7291 * any xacts we need to wait for.
7292 */
7294 if (nvxids > 0)
7295 {
7296 do
7297 {
7298 /*
7299 * Keep absorbing fsync requests while we wait. There could even
7300 * be a deadlock if we don't, if the process that prevents the
7301 * checkpoint is trying to add a request to the queue.
7302 */
7304
7306 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7310 }
7311 pfree(vxids);
7312
7313 CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
7314
7316 if (nvxids > 0)
7317 {
7318 do
7319 {
7321
7323 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7327 }
7328 pfree(vxids);
7329
7330 /*
7331 * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
7332 * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
7333 * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
7334 *
7335 * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
7336 * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
7337 */
7340
7342
7343 /*
7344 * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
7345 */
7347 XLogRegisterData(&checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
7351
7353
7354 /*
7355 * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
7356 * overwritten at next startup. No-one should even try, this just allows
7357 * sanity-checking. In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
7358 * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
7359 * recovery.
7360 */
7361 if (shutdown)
7362 {
7363 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7365 else
7366 LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
7367 }
7368
7369 /*
7370 * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
7371 * = end of actual checkpoint record.
7372 */
7373 if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
7374 ereport(PANIC,
7375 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
7376
7377 /*
7378 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7379 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7380 */
7382
7383 /*
7384 * Update the control file.
7385 */
7387 if (shutdown)
7390 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
7391 /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
7394
7395 /*
7396 * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
7397 * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
7398 * for debugging purposes.
7399 */
7401
7404
7405 /*
7406 * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
7407 * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
7408 */
7410
7411 /*
7412 * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
7413 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
7414 * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
7415 * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
7416 * happen before it can be summarized.
7417 *
7418 * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
7419 * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
7420 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
7421 * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7422 * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
7423 * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
7424 * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
7425 * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
7426 * record.
7427 */
7429
7430 /*
7431 * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
7432 */
7434
7435 /*
7436 * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
7437 * exists.
7438 */
7441
7442 INJECTION_POINT("checkpoint-before-old-wal-removal", NULL);
7443
7444 /*
7445 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
7446 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7447 */
7453 {
7454 /*
7455 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7456 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7457 */
7460 }
7461 _logSegNo--;
7463 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
7464
7465 /*
7466 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7467 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7468 */
7469 if (!shutdown)
7471
7472 /*
7473 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7474 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7475 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7476 * in subtrans.c). During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
7477 * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7478 */
7479 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7481
7482 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7483 LogCheckpointEnd(false);
7484
7485 /* Reset the process title */
7486 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
7487
7489 NBuffers,
7493
7494 return true;
7495}
7496
7497/*
7498 * Mark the end of recovery in WAL though without running a full checkpoint.
7499 * We can expect that a restartpoint is likely to be in progress as we
7500 * do this, though we are unwilling to wait for it to complete.
7501 *
7502 * CreateRestartPoint() allows for the case where recovery may end before
7503 * the restartpoint completes so there is no concern of concurrent behaviour.
7504 */
7505static void
7507{
7510
7511 /* sanity check */
7512 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7513 elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
7514
7515 xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7516 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
7517
7519 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7520 xlrec.PrevTimeLineID = XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID;
7522
7524
7528
7530
7531 /*
7532 * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
7533 * changes to this point.
7534 */
7537 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = xlrec.ThisTimeLineID;
7540
7542}
7543
7544/*
7545 * Write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message.
7546 *
7547 * When on WAL replay we expect a continuation record at the start of a page
7548 * that is not there, recovery ends and WAL writing resumes at that point.
7549 * But it's wrong to resume writing new WAL back at the start of the record
7550 * that was broken, because downstream consumers of that WAL (physical
7551 * replicas) are not prepared to "rewind". So the first action after
7552 * finishing replay of all valid WAL must be to write a record of this type
7553 * at the point where the contrecord was missing; to support xlogreader
7554 * detecting the special case, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD is also added
7555 * to the page header where the record occurs. xlogreader has an ad-hoc
7556 * mechanism to report metadata about the broken record, which is what we
7557 * use here.
7558 *
7559 * At replay time, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD instructs xlogreader to
7560 * skip the record it was reading, and pass back the LSN of the skipped
7561 * record, so that its caller can verify (on "replay" of that record) that the
7562 * XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD matches what was effectively overwritten.
7563 *
7564 * 'aborted_lsn' is the beginning position of the record that was incomplete.
7565 * It is included in the WAL record. 'pagePtr' and 'newTLI' point to the
7566 * beginning of the XLOG page where the record is to be inserted. They must
7567 * match the current WAL insert position, they're passed here just so that we
7568 * can verify that.
7569 */
7570static XLogRecPtr
7573{
7578
7579 /* sanity checks */
7580 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7581 elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
7582 if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
7583 elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%08X",
7585
7586 /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
7587 startPos = pagePtr;
7590 else
7593 if (recptr != startPos)
7594 elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%08X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
7596
7598
7599 /*
7600 * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
7601 * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
7602 *
7603 * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
7604 * insertion lock is just pro forma.
7605 */
7610
7611 /*
7612 * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
7613 * page. We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
7614 * allowed to write WAL yet.
7615 */
7617 xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
7618 xlrec.overwrite_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7621
7622 /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
7623 if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
7624 elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%08X",
7626
7628
7630
7631 return recptr;
7632}
7633
7634/*
7635 * Flush all data in shared memory to disk, and fsync
7636 *
7637 * This is the common code shared between regular checkpoints and
7638 * recovery restartpoints.
7639 */
7640static void
7642{
7648
7649 /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
7657 CheckPointBuffers(flags);
7658
7659 /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
7665
7666 /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
7668}
7669
7670/*
7671 * Save a checkpoint for recovery restart if appropriate
7672 *
7673 * This function is called each time a checkpoint record is read from XLOG.
7674 * It must determine whether the checkpoint represents a safe restartpoint or
7675 * not. If so, the checkpoint record is stashed in shared memory so that
7676 * CreateRestartPoint can consult it. (Note that the latter function is
7677 * executed by the checkpointer, while this one will be executed by the
7678 * startup process.)
7679 */
7680static void
7682{
7683 /*
7684 * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
7685 * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
7686 * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
7687 * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
7688 * later.
7689 */
7691 {
7692 elog(DEBUG2,
7693 "could not record restart point at %X/%08X because there are unresolved references to invalid pages",
7694 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
7695 return;
7696 }
7697
7698 /*
7699 * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
7700 * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
7701 */
7705 XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
7707}
7708
7709/*
7710 * Establish a restartpoint if possible.
7711 *
7712 * This is similar to CreateCheckPoint, but is used during WAL recovery
7713 * to establish a point from which recovery can roll forward without
7714 * replaying the entire recovery log.
7715 *
7716 * Returns true if a new restartpoint was established. We can only establish
7717 * a restartpoint if we have replayed a safe checkpoint record since last
7718 * restartpoint.
7719 */
7720bool
7722{
7723 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7724 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7725 CheckPoint lastCheckPoint;
7729 TimeLineID replayTLI;
7730 XLogRecPtr endptr;
7733
7734 /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
7736
7737 /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
7739 lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7740 lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7741 lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
7743
7744 /*
7745 * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
7746 * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
7747 */
7748 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7749 {
7751 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
7752 return false;
7753 }
7754
7755 /*
7756 * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
7757 * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
7758 * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
7759 * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
7760 * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
7761 * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
7762 * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
7763 * immediate shutdown, though.
7764 *
7765 * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
7766 * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
7767 * side-effect.
7768 */
7769 if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
7770 lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
7771 {
7773 errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%08X",
7774 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)));
7775
7777 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7778 {
7783 }
7784 return false;
7785 }
7786
7787 /*
7788 * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
7789 * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
7790 * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
7791 *
7792 * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
7793 * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
7794 * happening.
7795 */
7797 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7799
7800 /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
7802 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7804
7805 /*
7806 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7807 *
7808 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7809 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7810 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7811 */
7814
7815 if (log_checkpoints)
7816 LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
7817
7818 /* Update the process title */
7819 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
7820
7821 CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
7822
7823 /*
7824 * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
7825 * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
7826 */
7827 INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point", NULL);
7828
7829 /*
7830 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7831 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7832 */
7834
7835 /*
7836 * Update pg_control, using current time. Check that it still shows an
7837 * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
7838 * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
7839 * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
7840 */
7842 if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
7843 {
7844 /*
7845 * Update the checkpoint information. We do this even if the cluster
7846 * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
7847 * segments recycled below.
7848 */
7849 ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7850 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
7851
7852 /*
7853 * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
7854 * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY. Normally,
7855 * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
7856 * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied. We do
7857 * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
7858 * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
7859 * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
7860 * included, at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of
7861 * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
7862 * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
7863 * checkpoint record.
7864 */
7866 {
7867 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
7868 {
7869 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7871
7872 /* update local copy */
7875 }
7876 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7878 }
7880 }
7882
7883 /*
7884 * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
7885 * prior checkpoint exists.
7886 */
7889
7890 /*
7891 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
7892 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7893 */
7895
7896 /*
7897 * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
7898 * whichever is later.
7899 */
7901 replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
7902 endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
7903 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7904
7905 INJECTION_POINT("restartpoint-before-slot-invalidation", NULL);
7906
7910 {
7911 /*
7912 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7913 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7914 */
7916 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7917 }
7918 _logSegNo--;
7919
7920 /*
7921 * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
7922 * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
7923 * at end of recovery. If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
7924 * currently replaying.
7925 *
7926 * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
7927 * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
7928 * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
7929 * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
7930 * with that.
7931 */
7932 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7933 replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7934
7935 RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
7936
7937 /*
7938 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7939 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7940 */
7941 PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
7942
7943 /*
7944 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7945 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7946 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7947 * in subtrans.c). When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
7948 * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7949 */
7950 if (EnableHotStandby)
7952
7953 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7954 LogCheckpointEnd(true);
7955
7956 /* Reset the process title */
7957 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
7958
7961 errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%08X",
7962 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
7963 xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
7965
7966 /*
7967 * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
7968 */
7971 "archive_cleanup_command",
7972 false,
7974
7975 return true;
7976}
7977
7978/*
7979 * Report availability of WAL for the given target LSN
7980 * (typically a slot's restart_lsn)
7981 *
7982 * Returns one of the following enum values:
7983 *
7984 * * WALAVAIL_RESERVED means targetLSN is available and it is in the range of
7985 * max_wal_size.
7986 *
7987 * * WALAVAIL_EXTENDED means it is still available by preserving extra
7988 * segments beyond max_wal_size. If max_slot_wal_keep_size is smaller
7989 * than max_wal_size, this state is not returned.
7990 *
7991 * * WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED means it is being lost and the next checkpoint will
7992 * remove reserved segments. The walsender using this slot may return to the
7993 * above.
7994 *
7995 * * WALAVAIL_REMOVED means it has been removed. A replication stream on
7996 * a slot with this LSN cannot continue. (Any associated walsender
7997 * processes should have been terminated already.)
7998 *
7999 * * WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN means the slot hasn't been set to reserve WAL.
8000 */
8003{
8004 XLogRecPtr currpos; /* current write LSN */
8005 XLogSegNo currSeg; /* segid of currpos */
8006 XLogSegNo targetSeg; /* segid of targetLSN */
8007 XLogSegNo oldestSeg; /* actual oldest segid */
8008 XLogSegNo oldestSegMaxWalSize; /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
8009 XLogSegNo oldestSlotSeg; /* oldest segid kept by slot */
8011
8012 /*
8013 * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
8014 */
8016 return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
8017
8018 /*
8019 * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
8020 * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size. Initialize
8021 * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
8022 */
8023 currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
8025 KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
8026
8027 /*
8028 * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
8029 * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
8030 * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
8031 */
8033
8034 /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
8037
8038 if (currSeg > keepSegs)
8040 else
8042
8043 /* the segment we care about */
8045
8046 /*
8047 * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
8048 * targetSeg is known to be lost.
8049 */
8050 if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
8051 {
8052 /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
8054 return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
8055
8056 /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
8057 return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
8058 }
8059
8060 /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
8061 if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
8062 return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
8063
8064 /* Definitely lost */
8065 return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
8066}
8067
8068
8069/*
8070 * Retreat *logSegNo to the last segment that we need to retain because of
8071 * either wal_keep_size or replication slots.
8072 *
8073 * This is calculated by subtracting wal_keep_size from the given xlog
8074 * location, recptr and by making sure that that result is below the
8075 * requirement of replication slots. For the latter criterion we do consider
8076 * the effects of max_slot_wal_keep_size: reserve at most that much space back
8077 * from recptr.
8078 *
8079 * Note about replication slots: if this function calculates a value
8080 * that's further ahead than what slots need reserved, then affected
8081 * slots need to be invalidated and this function invoked again.
8082 * XXX it might be a good idea to rewrite this function so that
8083 * invalidation is optionally done here, instead.
8084 */
8085static void
8087{
8089 XLogSegNo segno;
8091
8093 segno = currSegNo;
8094
8095 /* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots. */
8098 {
8100
8101 /*
8102 * Account for max_slot_wal_keep_size to avoid keeping more than
8103 * configured. However, don't do that during a binary upgrade: if
8104 * slots were to be invalidated because of this, it would not be
8105 * possible to preserve logical ones during the upgrade.
8106 */
8108 {
8110
8113
8114 if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
8115 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
8116 }
8117 }
8118
8119 /*
8120 * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
8121 * summarized.
8122 */
8125 {
8127
8129 if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
8130 segno = unsummarized_segno;
8131 }
8132
8133 /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
8134 if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
8135 {
8137
8139 if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
8140 {
8141 /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
8142 if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
8143 segno = 1;
8144 else
8145 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
8146 }
8147 }
8148
8149 /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
8150 if (segno < *logSegNo)
8151 *logSegNo = segno;
8152}
8153
8154/*
8155 * Write a NEXTOID log record
8156 */
8157void
8159{
8161 XLogRegisterData(&nextOid, sizeof(Oid));
8163
8164 /*
8165 * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
8166 * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
8167 * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
8168 * record. Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
8169 * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
8170 * does.
8171 *
8172 * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
8173 * database. When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
8174 * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
8175 * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does. The impact
8176 * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
8177 * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
8178 * with the leftover file or directory. But since for safety's sake we
8179 * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
8180 * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
8181 */
8182}
8183
8184/*
8185 * Write an XLOG SWITCH record.
8186 *
8187 * Here we just blindly issue an XLogInsert request for the record.
8188 * All the magic happens inside XLogInsert.
8189 *
8190 * The return value is either the end+1 address of the switch record,
8191 * or the end+1 address of the prior segment if we did not need to
8192 * write a switch record because we are already at segment start.
8193 */
8196{
8198
8199 /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
8201
8202 if (mark_unimportant)
8205
8206 return RecPtr;
8207}
8208
8209/*
8210 * Write a RESTORE POINT record
8211 */
8214{
8217
8219 strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
8220
8223
8225
8226 ereport(LOG,
8227 errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%08X",
8229
8230 return RecPtr;
8231}
8232
8233/*
8234 * Check if any of the GUC parameters that are critical for hot standby
8235 * have changed, and update the value in pg_control file if necessary.
8236 */
8237static void
8239{
8248 {
8249 /*
8250 * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
8251 * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
8252 * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
8253 * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
8254 * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
8255 */
8257 {
8260
8262 xlrec.max_worker_processes = max_worker_processes;
8263 xlrec.max_wal_senders = max_wal_senders;
8264 xlrec.max_prepared_xacts = max_prepared_xacts;
8265 xlrec.max_locks_per_xact = max_locks_per_xact;
8266 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
8267 xlrec.wal_log_hints = wal_log_hints;
8268 xlrec.track_commit_timestamp = track_commit_timestamp;
8269
8271 XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
8272
8275 }
8276
8278
8288
8290 }
8291}
8292
8293/*
8294 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory, and write an
8295 * XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record if necessary.
8296 *
8297 * Note: this function assumes there is no other process running
8298 * concurrently that could update it.
8299 */
8300void
8302{
8304 bool recoveryInProgress;
8305
8306 /*
8307 * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
8308 *
8309 * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
8310 * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
8311 * can update it.
8312 */
8313 if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
8314 return;
8315
8316 /*
8317 * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
8318 * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
8319 * assertion failure.
8320 */
8322
8324
8325 /*
8326 * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
8327 * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
8328 * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
8329 * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
8330 * flag.
8331 */
8332 if (fullPageWrites)
8333 {
8335 Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
8337 }
8338
8339 /*
8340 * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
8341 * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
8342 */
8344 {
8346 XLogRegisterData(&fullPageWrites, sizeof(bool));
8347
8349 }
8350
8351 if (!fullPageWrites)
8352 {
8354 Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
8356 }
8358}
8359
8360/*
8361 * XLOG resource manager's routines
8362 *
8363 * Definitions of info values are in include/catalog/pg_control.h, though
8364 * not all record types are related to control file updates.
8365 *
8366 * NOTE: Some XLOG record types that are directly related to WAL recovery
8367 * are handled in xlogrecovery_redo().
8368 */
8369void
8371{
8372 uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
8373 XLogRecPtr lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
8374
8375 /*
8376 * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
8377 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
8378 */
8379 Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
8380 !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
8381
8382 if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
8383 {
8384 Oid nextOid;
8385
8386 /*
8387 * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
8388 * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
8389 * around. Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
8390 * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly. We still take
8391 * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
8392 */
8393 memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
8395 TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
8398 }
8399 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
8400 {
8401 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8402 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8403
8404 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8405 /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
8407 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8410 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
8414 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8415
8417 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8418
8419 /*
8420 * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
8421 * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
8422 */
8423 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8424
8425 /*
8426 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
8427 * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
8428 * never arrive.
8429 */
8433 ereport(PANIC,
8434 (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
8435
8436 /*
8437 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
8438 * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
8439 * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
8440 * for prepared transactions.
8441 */
8443 {
8444 TransactionId *xids;
8445 int nxids;
8447 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
8449
8451
8452 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
8454
8455 /*
8456 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
8457 * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
8458 * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
8459 * with their parent prepared transactions.
8460 */
8461 running.xcnt = nxids;
8462 running.subxcnt = 0;
8464 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8466 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8467 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
8468 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
8469 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
8470 running.xids = xids;
8471
8473 }
8474
8475 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8479
8480 /*
8481 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8482 * record.
8483 */
8484 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8485 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8486 ereport(PANIC,
8487 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
8488 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8489
8490 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8491
8492 /*
8493 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8494 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8495 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8496 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8497 */
8499 }
8500 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
8501 {
8502 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8503 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8504
8505 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8506 /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
8509 checkPoint.nextXid))
8510 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8512
8513 /*
8514 * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
8515 * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records. The nextOid
8516 * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
8517 * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records. We could try to take the
8518 * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
8519 * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
8520 * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do. In any case,
8521 * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
8522 * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
8523 */
8524
8525 /* Handle multixact */
8527 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8528
8529 /*
8530 * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
8531 * generated by an older primary.
8532 */
8534 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8536 checkPoint.oldestXid))
8538 checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8539 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8543
8544 /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
8545 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8546 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8547 ereport(PANIC,
8548 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
8549 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8550
8551 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8552
8553 /*
8554 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8555 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8556 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8557 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8558 */
8560 }
8561 else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
8562 {
8563 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8564 }
8565 else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
8566 {
8568 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8569
8570 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
8571
8572 /*
8573 * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
8574 * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
8575 * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
8576 */
8577
8578 /*
8579 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8580 * record.
8581 */
8582 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8583 if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8584 ereport(PANIC,
8585 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
8586 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8587 }
8588 else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
8589 {
8590 /* nothing to do here */
8591 }
8592 else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
8593 {
8594 /* nothing to do here */
8595 }
8596 else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
8597 {
8598 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
8599 }
8600 else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
8601 {
8602 /*
8603 * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
8604 * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
8605 * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
8606 * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
8607 *
8608 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
8609 * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
8610 * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
8611 * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
8612 * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
8613 *
8614 * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
8615 * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
8616 * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
8617 */
8618 for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
8619 {
8620 Buffer buffer;
8621
8622 if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
8623 {
8624 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
8625 elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
8626 continue;
8627 }
8628
8629 if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
8630 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
8631 UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
8632 }
8633 }
8634 else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
8635 {
8636 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8637 }
8638 else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
8639 {
8641
8642 /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
8643 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
8644
8646 ControlFile->MaxConnections = xlrec.MaxConnections;
8647 ControlFile->max_worker_processes = xlrec.max_worker_processes;
8648 ControlFile->max_wal_senders = xlrec.max_wal_senders;
8649 ControlFile->max_prepared_xacts = xlrec.max_prepared_xacts;
8650 ControlFile->max_locks_per_xact = xlrec.max_locks_per_xact;
8651 ControlFile->wal_level = xlrec.wal_level;
8652 ControlFile->wal_log_hints = xlrec.wal_log_hints;
8653
8654 /*
8655 * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
8656 * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
8657 * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
8658 * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
8659 * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
8660 * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
8661 */
8663 {
8666 }
8668 {
8669 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8670
8671 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8673 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
8674 }
8675
8676 CommitTsParameterChange(xlrec.track_commit_timestamp,
8678 ControlFile->track_commit_timestamp = xlrec.track_commit_timestamp;
8679
8682
8683 /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
8685 }
8686 else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
8687 {
8688 bool fpw;
8689
8690 memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
8691
8692 /*
8693 * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
8694 * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
8695 * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
8696 */
8697 if (!fpw)
8698 {
8703 }
8704
8705 /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
8707 }
8708 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
8709 {
8710 /* nothing to do here, just for informational purposes */
8711 }
8712 else if (info == XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE)
8713 {
8714 bool status;
8715
8716 memcpy(&status, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
8717
8718 /*
8719 * We need to toggle the logical decoding status and update the
8720 * XLogLogicalInfo cache of processes synchronously because
8721 * XLogLogicalInfoActive() is used even during read-only queries
8722 * (e.g., via RelationIsAccessibleInLogicalDecoding()). In the
8723 * 'disable' case, it is safe to invalidate existing slots after
8724 * disabling logical decoding because logical decoding cannot process
8725 * subsequent WAL records, which may not contain logical information.
8726 */
8727 if (status)
8729 else
8731
8732 elog(DEBUG1, "update logical decoding status to %d during recovery",
8733 status);
8734
8735 if (InRecovery && InHotStandby)
8736 {
8737 if (!status)
8738 {
8739 /*
8740 * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the
8741 * primary disabled logical decoding.
8742 */
8744 0, InvalidOid,
8746 }
8747 else if (sync_replication_slots)
8748 {
8749 /*
8750 * Signal the postmaster to launch the slotsync worker.
8751 *
8752 * XXX: For simplicity, we keep the slotsync worker running
8753 * even after logical decoding is disabled. A future
8754 * improvement can consider starting and stopping the worker
8755 * based on logical decoding status change.
8756 */
8758 }
8759 }
8760 }
8761}
8762
8763/*
8764 * Return the extra open flags used for opening a file, depending on the
8765 * value of the GUCs wal_sync_method, fsync and debug_io_direct.
8766 */
8767static int
8768get_sync_bit(int method)
8769{
8770 int o_direct_flag = 0;
8771
8772 /*
8773 * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process. The WAL
8774 * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
8775 * after it's written. Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
8776 * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
8777 */
8780
8781 /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
8782 if (!enableFsync)
8783 return o_direct_flag;
8784
8785 switch (method)
8786 {
8787 /*
8788 * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
8789 * not supported on the current platform. But if not, they are
8790 * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
8791 * be seen here.
8792 */
8796 return o_direct_flag;
8797#ifdef O_SYNC
8799 return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
8800#endif
8801#ifdef O_DSYNC
8803 return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
8804#endif
8805 default:
8806 /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
8807 elog(ERROR, "unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", method);
8808 return 0; /* silence warning */
8809 }
8810}
8811
8812/*
8813 * GUC support
8814 */
8815void
8817{
8819 {
8820 /*
8821 * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
8822 * currently open log segment (if any). Also, if the open flag is
8823 * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
8824 * bit) at next use.
8825 */
8826 if (openLogFile >= 0)
8827 {
8829 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
8830 {
8831 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8832 int save_errno;
8833
8834 save_errno = errno;
8837 errno = save_errno;
8838 ereport(PANIC,
8840 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
8841 }
8842
8845 XLogFileClose();
8846 }
8847 }
8848}
8849
8850
8851/*
8852 * Issue appropriate kind of fsync (if any) for an XLOG output file.
8853 *
8854 * 'fd' is a file descriptor for the XLOG file to be fsync'd.
8855 * 'segno' is for error reporting purposes.
8856 */
8857void
8859{
8860 char *msg = NULL;
8862
8863 Assert(tli != 0);
8864
8865 /*
8866 * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
8867 * file.
8868 */
8869 if (!enableFsync ||
8872 return;
8873
8874 /*
8875 * Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file for pg_stat_io.
8876 */
8878
8880 switch (wal_sync_method)
8881 {
8883 if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8884 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
8885 break;
8886#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
8888 if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8889 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
8890 break;
8891#endif
8893 if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
8894 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
8895 break;
8898 /* not reachable */
8899 Assert(false);
8900 break;
8901 default:
8902 ereport(PANIC,
8904 errmsg_internal("unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", wal_sync_method));
8905 break;
8906 }
8907
8908 /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
8909 if (msg)
8910 {
8911 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8912 int save_errno = errno;
8913
8915 errno = save_errno;
8916 ereport(PANIC,
8918 errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
8919 }
8920
8922
8924 start, 1, 0);
8925}
8926
8927/*
8928 * do_pg_backup_start is the workhorse of the user-visible pg_backup_start()
8929 * function. It creates the necessary starting checkpoint and constructs the
8930 * backup state and tablespace map.
8931 *
8932 * Input parameters are "state" (the backup state), "fast" (if true, we do
8933 * the checkpoint in fast mode), and "tablespaces" (if non-NULL, indicates a
8934 * list of tablespaceinfo structs describing the cluster's tablespaces.).
8935 *
8936 * The tablespace map contents are appended to passed-in parameter
8937 * tablespace_map and the caller is responsible for including it in the backup
8938 * archive as 'tablespace_map'. The tablespace_map file is required mainly for
8939 * tar format in windows as native windows utilities are not able to create
8940 * symlinks while extracting files from tar. However for consistency and
8941 * platform-independence, we do it the same way everywhere.
8942 *
8943 * It fills in "state" with the information required for the backup, such
8944 * as the minimum WAL location that must be present to restore from this
8945 * backup (starttli) and the corresponding timeline ID (starttli).
8946 *
8947 * Every successfully started backup must be stopped by calling
8948 * do_pg_backup_stop() or do_pg_abort_backup(). There can be many
8949 * backups active at the same time.
8950 *
8951 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
8952 * permissions of the calling user!
8953 */
8954void
8955do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces,
8957{
8959
8960 Assert(state != NULL);
8962
8963 /*
8964 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
8965 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
8966 */
8968 ereport(ERROR,
8970 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
8971 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
8972
8974 ereport(ERROR,
8976 errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
8977 MAXPGPATH)));
8978
8979 strlcpy(state->name, backupidstr, sizeof(state->name));
8980
8981 /*
8982 * Mark backup active in shared memory. We must do full-page WAL writes
8983 * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
8984 * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
8985 * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
8986 * our write to the same page. This can be fixed as long as the first
8987 * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
8988 * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
8989 * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
8990 * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record. (Once the
8991 * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
8992 * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
8993 * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
8994 *
8995 * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
8996 * backup from the standby.
8997 *
8998 * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
8999 * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
9000 * XLogInsertRecord().
9001 */
9005
9006 /*
9007 * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
9008 * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
9009 * after this block is over.
9010 */
9012 {
9013 bool gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
9014 DIR *tblspcdir;
9015 struct dirent *de;
9017 int datadirpathlen;
9018
9019 /*
9020 * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
9021 * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
9022 * old timeline IDs. That would otherwise happen if you called
9023 * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
9024 * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
9025 * the beginning with the old timeline ID. That can cause trouble at
9026 * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
9027 * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
9028 * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
9029 *
9030 * This also ensures that we have emitted a WAL page header that has
9031 * XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE off before we emit the checkpoint record.
9032 * Therefore, if a WAL archiver (such as pglesslog) is trying to
9033 * compress out removable backup blocks, it won't remove any that
9034 * occur after this point.
9035 *
9036 * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
9037 * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
9038 * recovery case described above.
9039 */
9041 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9042
9043 do
9044 {
9045 bool checkpointfpw;
9046
9047 /*
9048 * Force a CHECKPOINT. Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
9049 * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
9050 * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
9051 * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
9052 *
9053 * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
9054 * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
9055 * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
9056 * positions.
9057 *
9058 * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
9059 * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
9060 * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
9061 *
9062 * We use CHECKPOINT_FAST only if requested by user (via passing
9063 * fast = true). Otherwise this can take awhile.
9064 */
9066 (fast ? CHECKPOINT_FAST : 0));
9067
9068 /*
9069 * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
9070 * its REDO pointer. The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
9071 * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
9072 * pointer.
9073 */
9075 state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
9076 state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
9080
9082 {
9084
9085 /*
9086 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
9087 * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
9088 * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
9089 */
9093
9094 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
9095 ereport(ERROR,
9097 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9098 "since last restartpoint"),
9099 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9100 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9101 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9102 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9103
9104 /*
9105 * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
9106 * record and don't write the backup history file, the
9107 * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
9108 * that two base backups started at the same time might use
9109 * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
9110 */
9111 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9112 }
9113
9114 /*
9115 * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
9116 * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
9117 * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
9118 * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
9119 * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
9120 * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
9121 * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
9122 * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
9123 * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
9124 */
9126 if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
9127 {
9128 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
9129 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9130 }
9132 } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
9133
9134 /*
9135 * Construct tablespace_map file.
9136 */
9138
9139 /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
9141 while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, PG_TBLSPC_DIR)) != NULL)
9142 {
9143 char fullpath[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(PG_TBLSPC_DIR)];
9144 char linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
9145 char *relpath = NULL;
9146 char *s;
9148 char *badp;
9149 Oid tsoid;
9150
9151 /*
9152 * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
9153 *
9154 * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
9155 * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
9156 * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
9157 * criteria, skip it.
9158 */
9159 if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
9160 continue;
9161 errno = 0;
9162 tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
9163 if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
9164 continue;
9165
9166 snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "%s/%s", PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9167
9168 de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
9169
9170 if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
9171 {
9173 int rllen;
9174
9175 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
9176 if (rllen < 0)
9177 {
9179 (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
9180 fullpath)));
9181 continue;
9182 }
9183 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
9184 {
9186 (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
9187 fullpath)));
9188 continue;
9189 }
9190 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
9191
9192 /*
9193 * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
9194 * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
9195 * elsewhere.
9196 */
9197 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
9201
9202 /*
9203 * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
9204 * tablespace map file.
9205 */
9207 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
9208 {
9209 if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
9212 }
9214 de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
9215 pfree(escapedpath.data);
9216 }
9217 else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
9218 {
9219 /*
9220 * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
9221 * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
9222 * only.
9223 *
9224 * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
9225 * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
9226 */
9227 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "%s/%s",
9228 PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9230 }
9231 else
9232 {
9233 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
9234 continue;
9235 }
9236
9238 ti->oid = tsoid;
9239 ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
9240 ti->rpath = relpath;
9241 ti->size = -1;
9242
9243 if (tablespaces)
9244 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
9245 }
9247
9248 state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9249 }
9251
9252 state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
9253
9254 /*
9255 * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
9256 */
9258}
9259
9260/*
9261 * Utility routine to fetch the session-level status of a backup running.
9262 */
9265{
9266 return sessionBackupState;
9267}
9268
9269/*
9270 * do_pg_backup_stop
9271 *
9272 * Utility function called at the end of an online backup. It creates history
9273 * file (if required), resets sessionBackupState and so on. It can optionally
9274 * wait for WAL segments to be archived.
9275 *
9276 * "state" is filled with the information necessary to restore from this
9277 * backup with its stop LSN (stoppoint), its timeline ID (stoptli), etc.
9278 *
9279 * It is the responsibility of the caller of this function to verify the
9280 * permissions of the calling user!
9281 */
9282void
9284{
9285 bool backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
9286 char histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
9290 FILE *fp;
9292 int waits = 0;
9293 bool reported_waiting = false;
9294
9295 Assert(state != NULL);
9296
9298
9299 /*
9300 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
9301 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
9302 */
9304 ereport(ERROR,
9306 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
9307 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
9308
9309 /*
9310 * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
9311 *
9312 * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
9313 * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
9314 * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
9315 */
9317
9318 /*
9319 * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
9320 * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
9321 */
9324
9325 /*
9326 * Clean up session-level lock.
9327 *
9328 * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
9329 * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
9330 * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
9331 * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
9332 * cleaned up before it.
9333 */
9335
9337
9338 /*
9339 * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
9340 * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
9341 */
9342 if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
9343 ereport(ERROR,
9345 errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
9346 errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
9347 "and should not be used. "
9348 "Try taking another online backup.")));
9349
9350 /*
9351 * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
9352 * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
9353 * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
9354 * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
9355 * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
9356 * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
9357 * however.
9358 *
9359 * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
9360 * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
9361 * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
9362 * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
9363 * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
9364 * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
9365 * available.
9366 *
9367 * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
9368 * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
9369 * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
9370 * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
9371 *
9372 * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
9373 * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
9374 * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
9375 * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
9376 * backup history file during recovery.
9377 */
9379 {
9381
9382 /*
9383 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
9384 * full-page writes.
9385 */
9389
9390 if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
9391 ereport(ERROR,
9393 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9394 "during online backup"),
9395 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9396 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9397 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9398 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9399
9400
9402 state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
9405 }
9406 else
9407 {
9408 char *history_file;
9409
9410 /*
9411 * Write the backup-end xlog record
9412 */
9414 XLogRegisterData(&state->startpoint,
9415 sizeof(state->startpoint));
9417
9418 /*
9419 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
9420 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
9421 */
9422 state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
9423
9424 /*
9425 * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
9426 * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
9427 */
9428 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9429
9430 state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9431
9432 /*
9433 * Write the backup history file
9434 */
9437 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9438 fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
9439 if (!fp)
9440 ereport(ERROR,
9442 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
9443 histfilepath)));
9444
9445 /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
9447 fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
9449
9450 if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
9451 ereport(ERROR,
9453 errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
9454 histfilepath)));
9455
9456 /*
9457 * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files. As a side effect,
9458 * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
9459 * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
9460 * immediately.
9461 */
9463 }
9464
9465 /*
9466 * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
9467 * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
9468 * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
9469 * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
9470 * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
9471 * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
9472 * the required WAL.
9473 *
9474 * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
9475 * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
9476 * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
9477 * archived as well.
9478 *
9479 * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
9480 * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
9481 * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
9482 * or you can set statement_timeout. Also, some notices are issued to
9483 * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
9484 */
9485
9486 if (waitforarchive &&
9489 {
9493
9496 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9497
9499 waits = 0;
9500
9503 {
9505
9506 if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
9507 {
9509 (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
9510 reported_waiting = true;
9511 }
9512
9515 1000L,
9518
9520 {
9521 seconds_before_warning *= 2; /* This wraps in >10 years... */
9523 (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
9524 waits),
9525 errhint("Check that your \"archive_command\" is executing properly. "
9526 "You can safely cancel this backup, "
9527 "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
9528 }
9529 }
9530
9532 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
9533 }
9534 else if (waitforarchive)
9536 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
9537}
9538
9539
9540/*
9541 * do_pg_abort_backup: abort a running backup
9542 *
9543 * This does just the most basic steps of do_pg_backup_stop(), by taking the
9544 * system out of backup mode, thus making it a lot more safe to call from
9545 * an error handler.
9546 *
9547 * 'arg' indicates that it's being called during backup setup; so
9548 * sessionBackupState has not been modified yet, but runningBackups has
9549 * already been incremented. When it's false, then it's invoked as a
9550 * before_shmem_exit handler, and therefore we must not change state
9551 * unless sessionBackupState indicates that a backup is actually running.
9552 *
9553 * NB: This gets used as a PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP callback and
9554 * before_shmem_exit handler, hence the odd-looking signature.
9555 */
9556void
9558{
9560
9561 /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
9563
9565 {
9569
9572
9575 errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
9576 }
9577}
9578
9579/*
9580 * Register a handler that will warn about unterminated backups at end of
9581 * session, unless this has already been done.
9582 */
9583void
9585{
9586 static bool already_done = false;
9587
9588 if (already_done)
9589 return;
9591 already_done = true;
9592}
9593
9594/*
9595 * Get latest WAL insert pointer
9596 */
9599{
9602
9603 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9604 current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
9605 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9606
9608}
9609
9610/*
9611 * Get latest WAL write pointer
9612 */
9620
9621/*
9622 * Returns the redo pointer of the last checkpoint or restartpoint. This is
9623 * the oldest point in WAL that we still need, if we have to restart recovery.
9624 */
9625void
9633
9634/* Thin wrapper around ShutdownWalRcv(). */
9635void
9643
9644/* Enable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
9645void
9652
9653/* Disable WAL file recycling and preallocation. */
9654void
9661
9662bool
9664{
9665 bool result;
9666
9670
9671 return result;
9672}
9673
9674/*
9675 * Update the WalWriterSleeping flag.
9676 */
9677void
Datum idx(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition _int_op.c:262
static void pg_atomic_write_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:485
#define pg_memory_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:141
#define pg_read_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:154
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:476
#define pg_write_barrier()
Definition atomics.h:155
static uint64 pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 target)
Definition atomics.h:595
static uint64 pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, int64 add_)
Definition atomics.h:532
static void pg_atomic_init_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:453
static void pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition atomics.h:504
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition atomics.h:467
TimeLineID findNewestTimeLine(TimeLineID startTLI)
Definition timeline.c:264
void restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(TimeLineID begin, TimeLineID end)
Definition timeline.c:50
void writeTimeLineHistory(TimeLineID newTLI, TimeLineID parentTLI, XLogRecPtr switchpoint, char *reason)
Definition timeline.c:304
void startup_progress_timeout_handler(void)
Definition startup.c:302
long TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time)
Definition timestamp.c:1757
bool TimestampDifferenceExceeds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time, int msec)
Definition timestamp.c:1781
TimestampTz GetCurrentTimestamp(void)
Definition timestamp.c:1645
const char * timestamptz_to_str(TimestampTz t)
Definition timestamp.c:1862
Datum now(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition timestamp.c:1609
static bool backup_started_in_recovery
Definition basebackup.c:123
int Buffer
Definition buf.h:23
void CheckPointBuffers(int flags)
Definition bufmgr.c:4342
void UnlockReleaseBuffer(Buffer buffer)
Definition bufmgr.c:5518
#define Min(x, y)
Definition c.h:997
#define pg_attribute_unused()
Definition c.h:132
#define likely(x)
Definition c.h:411
#define MAXALIGN(LEN)
Definition c.h:826
#define TYPEALIGN(ALIGNVAL, LEN)
Definition c.h:819
uint8_t uint8
Definition c.h:544
#define Max(x, y)
Definition c.h:991
#define Assert(condition)
Definition c.h:873
#define PG_BINARY
Definition c.h:1287
#define pg_attribute_always_inline
Definition c.h:279
uint64_t uint64
Definition c.h:547
#define unlikely(x)
Definition c.h:412
uint32_t uint32
Definition c.h:546
#define MAXALIGN64(LEN)
Definition c.h:851
#define PG_UINT64_MAX
Definition c.h:607
#define MemSet(start, val, len)
Definition c.h:1013
uint32 TransactionId
Definition c.h:666
size_t Size
Definition c.h:619
#define CATALOG_VERSION_NO
Definition catversion.h:60
void WakeupCheckpointer(void)
void AbsorbSyncRequests(void)
double CheckPointCompletionTarget
void RequestCheckpoint(int flags)
void BootStrapCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:832
void StartupCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:843
void CheckPointCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:903
void TrimCLOG(void)
Definition clog.c:858
void StartupCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:608
void CommitTsParameterChange(bool newvalue, bool oldvalue)
Definition commit_ts.c:640
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition commit_ts.c:109
void CompleteCommitTsInitialization(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:618
void BootStrapCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:594
void SetCommitTsLimit(TransactionId oldestXact, TransactionId newestXact)
Definition commit_ts.c:887
void CheckPointCommitTs(void)
Definition commit_ts.c:794
void update_controlfile(const char *DataDir, ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool do_sync)
#define fprintf(file, fmt, msg)
Definition cubescan.l:21
int64 TimestampTz
Definition timestamp.h:39
int errmsg_plural(const char *fmt_singular, const char *fmt_plural, unsigned long n,...)
Definition elog.c:1193
int errmsg_internal(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1170
int errcode_for_file_access(void)
Definition elog.c:886
int errdetail(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1216
int errhint(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1330
int errcode(int sqlerrcode)
Definition elog.c:863
int errmsg(const char *fmt,...)
Definition elog.c:1080
#define _(x)
Definition elog.c:91
#define LOG
Definition elog.h:31
#define FATAL
Definition elog.h:41
#define WARNING
Definition elog.h:36
#define DEBUG2
Definition elog.h:29
#define PANIC
Definition elog.h:42
#define DEBUG1
Definition elog.h:30
#define ERROR
Definition elog.h:39
#define elog(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:226
#define NOTICE
Definition elog.h:35
#define ereport(elevel,...)
Definition elog.h:150
int MakePGDirectory(const char *directoryName)
Definition fd.c:3962
int FreeDir(DIR *dir)
Definition fd.c:3008
int pg_fsync_no_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:441
int io_direct_flags
Definition fd.c:171
int durable_rename(const char *oldfile, const char *newfile, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:782
int pg_fdatasync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:480
int CloseTransientFile(int fd)
Definition fd.c:2854
int BasicOpenFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:1089
int FreeFile(FILE *file)
Definition fd.c:2826
int pg_fsync_writethrough(int fd)
Definition fd.c:461
void ReleaseExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1224
int data_sync_elevel(int elevel)
Definition fd.c:3985
static void Insert(File file)
Definition fd.c:1300
DIR * AllocateDir(const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2890
int durable_unlink(const char *fname, int elevel)
Definition fd.c:872
void ReserveExternalFD(void)
Definition fd.c:1206
struct dirent * ReadDir(DIR *dir, const char *dirname)
Definition fd.c:2956
int pg_fsync(int fd)
Definition fd.c:389
FILE * AllocateFile(const char *name, const char *mode)
Definition fd.c:2627
int OpenTransientFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition fd.c:2677
void SyncDataDirectory(void)
Definition fd.c:3593
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL
Definition fd.h:55
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT
Definition fd.h:56
#define PG_O_DIRECT
Definition fd.h:123
#define palloc_object(type)
Definition fe_memutils.h:74
ssize_t pg_pwrite_zeros(int fd, size_t size, pgoff_t offset)
Definition file_utils.c:709
PGFileType get_dirent_type(const char *path, const struct dirent *de, bool look_through_symlinks, int elevel)
Definition file_utils.c:547
PGFileType
Definition file_utils.h:19
@ PGFILETYPE_LNK
Definition file_utils.h:24
@ PGFILETYPE_DIR
Definition file_utils.h:23
@ PGFILETYPE_REG
Definition file_utils.h:22
bool IsBinaryUpgrade
Definition globals.c:121
int NBuffers
Definition globals.c:142
pid_t PostmasterPid
Definition globals.c:106
bool enableFsync
Definition globals.c:129
ProcNumber MyProcNumber
Definition globals.c:90
bool IsUnderPostmaster
Definition globals.c:120
int MaxConnections
Definition globals.c:143
volatile uint32 CritSectionCount
Definition globals.c:45
char * DataDir
Definition globals.c:71
bool IsPostmasterEnvironment
Definition globals.c:119
struct Latch * MyLatch
Definition globals.c:63
int max_worker_processes
Definition globals.c:144
int set_config_option_ext(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source, Oid srole, GucAction action, bool changeVal, int elevel, bool is_reload)
Definition guc.c:3256
void SetConfigOption(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source)
Definition guc.c:4196
void * guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size)
Definition guc.c:636
#define newval
struct config_generic * find_option(const char *name, bool create_placeholders, bool skip_errors, int elevel)
Definition guc.c:1113
@ GUC_ACTION_SET
Definition guc.h:203
#define GUC_check_errdetail
Definition guc.h:505
GucSource
Definition guc.h:112
@ PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT
Definition guc.h:114
@ PGC_S_OVERRIDE
Definition guc.h:123
@ PGC_INTERNAL
Definition guc.h:73
@ PGC_POSTMASTER
Definition guc.h:74
return str start
#define TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE
Definition heaptoast.h:84
#define bufsize
#define INJECTION_POINT(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_CACHED(name, arg)
#define INJECTION_POINT_LOAD(name)
WalUsage pgWalUsage
Definition instrument.c:22
#define close(a)
Definition win32.h:12
#define write(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:14
#define read(a, b, c)
Definition win32.h:13
void before_shmem_exit(pg_on_exit_callback function, Datum arg)
Definition ipc.c:344
#define PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:47
#define PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition ipc.h:52
int i
Definition isn.c:77
#define LOBLKSIZE
void SetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:290
void ResetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition latch.c:374
int WaitLatch(Latch *latch, int wakeEvents, long timeout, uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition latch.c:172
List * lappend(List *list, void *datum)
Definition list.c:339
void list_free(List *list)
Definition list.c:1546
int max_locks_per_xact
Definition lock.c:53
void UpdateLogicalDecodingStatusEndOfRecovery(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:553
bool IsLogicalDecodingEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:204
bool IsXLogLogicalInfoEnabled(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:220
void StartupLogicalDecodingStatus(bool last_status)
Definition logicalctl.c:146
void DisableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:491
void EnableLogicalDecoding(void)
Definition logicalctl.c:340
void LWLockUpdateVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1728
void LWLockReleaseClearVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition lwlock.c:1866
bool LWLockAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1176
bool LWLockWaitForVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 oldval, uint64 *newval)
Definition lwlock.c:1592
void LWLockRelease(LWLock *lock)
Definition lwlock.c:1793
void LWLockInitialize(LWLock *lock, int tranche_id)
Definition lwlock.c:698
bool LWLockConditionalAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1347
bool LWLockAcquireOrWait(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition lwlock.c:1404
@ LW_SHARED
Definition lwlock.h:113
@ LW_EXCLUSIVE
Definition lwlock.h:112
char * pstrdup(const char *in)
Definition mcxt.c:1781
void pfree(void *pointer)
Definition mcxt.c:1616
MemoryContext TopMemoryContext
Definition mcxt.c:166
void * palloc(Size size)
Definition mcxt.c:1387
void MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(MemoryContext context, bool allow)
Definition mcxt.c:743
#define AllocSetContextCreate
Definition memutils.h:129
#define ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES
Definition memutils.h:160
#define AmStartupProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:390
#define IsBootstrapProcessingMode()
Definition miscadmin.h:477
#define START_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:150
#define CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS()
Definition miscadmin.h:123
@ B_CHECKPOINTER
Definition miscadmin.h:363
#define END_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition miscadmin.h:152
#define AmWalReceiverProcess()
Definition miscadmin.h:391
bool process_shared_preload_libraries_done
Definition miscinit.c:1787
BackendType MyBackendType
Definition miscinit.c:64
void MultiXactSetNextMXact(MultiXactId nextMulti, MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:1992
void MultiXactAdvanceOldest(MultiXactId oldestMulti, Oid oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:2191
void MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(bool is_shutdown, MultiXactId *nextMulti, MultiXactOffset *nextMultiOffset, MultiXactId *oldestMulti, Oid *oldestMultiDB)
Definition multixact.c:1946
void CheckPointMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1968
void TrimMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1834
void MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(MultiXactId minMulti, MultiXactOffset minMultiOffset)
Definition multixact.c:2164
void BootStrapMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1793
void StartupMultiXact(void)
Definition multixact.c:1809
void SetMultiXactIdLimit(MultiXactId oldest_datminmxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition multixact.c:2014
#define FirstMultiXactId
Definition multixact.h:26
void StartupReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:730
void CheckPointReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition origin.c:604
static MemoryContext MemoryContextSwitchTo(MemoryContext context)
Definition palloc.h:124
void * arg
#define ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED
#define INDEX_MAX_KEYS
#define NAMEDATALEN
#define MAXPGPATH
#define DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE
#define SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT
#define PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE
#define PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE
#define FLOATFORMAT_VALUE
Definition pg_control.h:203
#define XLOG_RESTORE_POINT
Definition pg_control.h:76
#define XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:77
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
Definition pg_control.h:83
#define PG_CONTROL_VERSION
Definition pg_control.h:25
#define XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
Definition pg_control.h:82
#define XLOG_FPI
Definition pg_control.h:80
#define XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT
Definition pg_control.h:79
#define MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN
Definition pg_control.h:28
#define XLOG_NEXTOID
Definition pg_control.h:72
@ DB_IN_PRODUCTION
Definition pg_control.h:99
@ DB_SHUTDOWNING
Definition pg_control.h:96
@ DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:98
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:95
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED
Definition pg_control.h:94
@ DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:97
#define XLOG_NOOP
Definition pg_control.h:71
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN
Definition pg_control.h:69
#define PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE
Definition pg_control.h:260
#define XLOG_SWITCH
Definition pg_control.h:73
#define XLOG_BACKUP_END
Definition pg_control.h:74
#define XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:75
#define XLOG_LOGICAL_DECODING_STATUS_CHANGE
Definition pg_control.h:84
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
Definition pg_control.h:70
#define XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition pg_control.h:78
uint32 pg_crc32c
Definition pg_crc32c.h:38
#define COMP_CRC32C(crc, data, len)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:153
#define EQ_CRC32C(c1, c2)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:42
#define INIT_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:41
#define FIN_CRC32C(crc)
Definition pg_crc32c.h:158
const void size_t len
return crc
static char * filename
Definition pg_dumpall.c:120
#define lfirst(lc)
Definition pg_list.h:172
static rewind_source * source
Definition pg_rewind.c:89
static char buf[DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE]
bool pgstat_report_fixed
Definition pgstat.c:218
void pgstat_restore_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:507
void pgstat_discard_stats(void)
Definition pgstat.c:519
@ IOOBJECT_WAL
Definition pgstat.h:279
@ IOCONTEXT_INIT
Definition pgstat.h:288
@ IOCONTEXT_NORMAL
Definition pgstat.h:289
@ IOOP_FSYNC
Definition pgstat.h:308
@ IOOP_WRITE
Definition pgstat.h:316
PgStat_CheckpointerStats PendingCheckpointerStats
instr_time pgstat_prepare_io_time(bool track_io_guc)
Definition pgstat_io.c:91
void pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOObject io_object, IOContext io_context, IOOp io_op, instr_time start_time, uint32 cnt, uint64 bytes)
Definition pgstat_io.c:122
int64 pg_time_t
Definition pgtime.h:23
size_t pg_strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, const struct pg_tm *t)
Definition strftime.c:128
struct pg_tm * pg_localtime(const pg_time_t *timep, const pg_tz *tz)
Definition localtime.c:1345
PGDLLIMPORT pg_tz * log_timezone
Definition pgtz.c:31
bool pg_strong_random(void *buf, size_t len)
int pg_strcasecmp(const char *s1, const char *s2)
#define pg_pwrite
Definition port.h:248
#define snprintf
Definition port.h:260
#define IS_DIR_SEP(ch)
Definition port.h:103
size_t strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t siz)
Definition strlcpy.c:45
static bool DatumGetBool(Datum X)
Definition postgres.h:100
static Datum BoolGetDatum(bool X)
Definition postgres.h:112
uint64_t Datum
Definition postgres.h:70
#define InvalidOid
unsigned int Oid
void CheckPointPredicate(void)
Definition predicate.c:1041
static int fd(const char *x, int i)
static int fb(int x)
short access
#define GetPGProcByNumber(n)
Definition proc.h:440
#define DELAY_CHKPT_START
Definition proc.h:136
#define DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE
Definition proc.h:137
bool MinimumActiveBackends(int min)
Definition procarray.c:3495
TransactionId GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning(void)
Definition procarray.c:1979
bool HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(VirtualTransactionId *vxids, int nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3047
void ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(RunningTransactions running)
Definition procarray.c:1051
TransactionId GetOldestActiveTransactionId(bool inCommitOnly, bool allDbs)
Definition procarray.c:2830
void ProcArrayInitRecovery(TransactionId initializedUptoXID)
Definition procarray.c:1020
VirtualTransactionId * GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(int *nvxids, int type)
Definition procarray.c:3002
#define INVALID_PROC_NUMBER
Definition procnumber.h:26
int ProcNumber
Definition procnumber.h:24
static void set_ps_display(const char *activity)
Definition ps_status.h:40
void ResetUnloggedRelations(int op)
Definition reinit.c:47
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT
Definition reinit.h:28
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP
Definition reinit.h:27
void RelationCacheInitFileRemove(void)
Definition relcache.c:6895
void CheckPointRelationMap(void)
Definition relmapper.c:611
#define relpath(rlocator, forknum)
Definition relpath.h:150
#define PG_TBLSPC_DIR
Definition relpath.h:41
void StartupReorderBuffer(void)
ResourceOwner CurrentResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:173
ResourceOwner AuxProcessResourceOwner
Definition resowner.c:176
void CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(void)
#define RM_MAX_ID
Definition rmgr.h:33
Size add_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition shmem.c:482
Size mul_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition shmem.c:497
void * ShmemInitStruct(const char *name, Size size, bool *foundPtr)
Definition shmem.c:378
void pg_usleep(long microsec)
Definition signal.c:53
void CheckPointReplicationSlots(bool is_shutdown)
Definition slot.c:2300
void StartupReplicationSlots(void)
Definition slot.c:2378
bool InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(uint32 possible_causes, XLogSegNo oldestSegno, Oid dboid, TransactionId snapshotConflictHorizon)
Definition slot.c:2196
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED
Definition slot.h:62
@ RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT
Definition slot.h:68
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL
Definition slot.h:66
bool sync_replication_slots
Definition slotsync.c:117
void smgrdestroyall(void)
Definition smgr.c:386
void CheckPointSnapBuild(void)
Definition snapbuild.c:1969
void DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles(void)
Definition snapmgr.c:1587
#define SpinLockInit(lock)
Definition spin.h:57
#define SpinLockRelease(lock)
Definition spin.h:61
#define SpinLockAcquire(lock)
Definition spin.h:59
void reset(void)
PGPROC * MyProc
Definition proc.c:67
PROC_HDR * ProcGlobal
Definition proc.c:79
XLogRecPtr LogStandbySnapshot(void)
Definition standby.c:1281
void InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:95
void ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition standby.c:161
@ SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS
Definition standby.h:82
void appendStringInfo(StringInfo str, const char *fmt,...)
Definition stringinfo.c:145
void appendBinaryStringInfo(StringInfo str, const void *data, int datalen)
Definition stringinfo.c:281
void appendStringInfoString(StringInfo str, const char *s)
Definition stringinfo.c:230
void appendStringInfoChar(StringInfo str, char ch)
Definition stringinfo.c:242
void initStringInfo(StringInfo str)
Definition stringinfo.c:97
Oid oldestMultiDB
Definition pg_control.h:52
MultiXactId oldestMulti
Definition pg_control.h:51
MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset
Definition pg_control.h:48
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:56
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition pg_control.h:49
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:40
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID
Definition pg_control.h:39
TransactionId oldestActiveXid
Definition pg_control.h:65
bool fullPageWrites
Definition pg_control.h:42
MultiXactId nextMulti
Definition pg_control.h:47
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition pg_control.h:45
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition pg_control.h:54
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:53
int wal_level
Definition pg_control.h:43
bool logicalDecodingEnabled
Definition pg_control.h:44
XLogRecPtr redo
Definition pg_control.h:37
Oid oldestXidDB
Definition pg_control.h:50
uint64 ckpt_agg_sync_time
Definition xlog.h:187
uint64 ckpt_longest_sync
Definition xlog.h:186
TimestampTz ckpt_start_t
Definition xlog.h:172
TimestampTz ckpt_end_t
Definition xlog.h:176
int ckpt_segs_removed
Definition xlog.h:182
TimestampTz ckpt_write_t
Definition xlog.h:173
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_end_t
Definition xlog.h:175
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_t
Definition xlog.h:174
int ckpt_bufs_written
Definition xlog.h:178
int ckpt_segs_recycled
Definition xlog.h:183
int ckpt_slru_written
Definition xlog.h:179
char mock_authentication_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN]
Definition pg_control.h:239
uint32 pg_control_version
Definition pg_control.h:127
uint32 xlog_seg_size
Definition pg_control.h:215
XLogRecPtr backupStartPoint
Definition pg_control.h:172
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition pg_control.h:187
CheckPoint checkPointCopy
Definition pg_control.h:137
uint32 slru_pages_per_segment
Definition pg_control.h:212
XLogRecPtr backupEndPoint
Definition pg_control.h:173
XLogRecPtr minRecoveryPoint
Definition pg_control.h:170
uint32 data_checksum_version
Definition pg_control.h:226
XLogRecPtr unloggedLSN
Definition pg_control.h:139
uint32 indexMaxKeys
Definition pg_control.h:218
pg_time_t time
Definition pg_control.h:134
bool default_char_signedness
Definition pg_control.h:232
XLogRecPtr checkPoint
Definition pg_control.h:135
uint64 system_identifier
Definition pg_control.h:112
uint32 catalog_version_no
Definition pg_control.h:128
TimeLineID minRecoveryPointTLI
Definition pg_control.h:171
pg_crc32c crc
Definition pg_control.h:242
uint32 toast_max_chunk_size
Definition pg_control.h:220
Definition dirent.c:26
Definition pg_list.h:54
char data[XLOG_BLCKSZ]
Definition c.h:1137
ProcNumber walwriterProc
Definition proc.h:424
PgStat_Counter sync_time
Definition pgstat.h:265
PgStat_Counter write_time
Definition pgstat.h:264
void(* rm_mask)(char *pagedata, BlockNumber blkno)
TransactionId oldestRunningXid
Definition standby.h:92
TransactionId nextXid
Definition standby.h:91
TransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition standby.h:95
subxids_array_status subxid_status
Definition standby.h:90
TransactionId * xids
Definition standby.h:97
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:232
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition transam.h:233
FullTransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition transam.h:238
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition transam.h:220
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition transam.h:222
pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt
Definition xlog.c:373
XLogRecPtr lastImportantAt
Definition xlog.c:374
LWLock lock
Definition xlog.c:372
pg_atomic_uint64 minWaitedLSN[WAIT_LSN_TYPE_COUNT]
Definition xlogwait.h:85
int64 wal_buffers_full
Definition instrument.h:57
uint64 wal_bytes
Definition instrument.h:55
int64 wal_fpi
Definition instrument.h:54
uint64 wal_fpi_bytes
Definition instrument.h:56
int64 wal_records
Definition instrument.h:53
CheckPoint lastCheckPoint
Definition xlog.c:547
XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst
Definition xlog.c:458
slock_t info_lck
Definition xlog.c:555
XLogRecPtr InitializedUpTo
Definition xlog.c:487
char * pages
Definition xlog.c:494
pg_time_t lastSegSwitchTime
Definition xlog.c:469
XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN
Definition xlog.c:461
RecoveryState SharedRecoveryState
Definition xlog.c:518
TimeLineID InsertTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:511
XLogRecPtr lastSegSwitchLSN
Definition xlog.c:470
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo
Definition xlog.c:463
pg_atomic_uint64 * xlblocks
Definition xlog.c:495
pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult
Definition xlog.c:474
int XLogCacheBlck
Definition xlog.c:496
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:459
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:545
XLogRecPtr lastFpwDisableRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:553
XLogCtlInsert Insert
Definition xlog.c:455
bool InstallXLogFileSegmentActive
Definition xlog.c:528
bool WalWriterSleeping
Definition xlog.c:535
XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN
Definition xlog.c:460
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr
Definition xlog.c:546
pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult
Definition xlog.c:475
pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult
Definition xlog.c:473
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:512
pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN
Definition xlog.c:466
WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:447
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:433
uint64 PrevBytePos
Definition xlog.c:411
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:420
int runningBackups
Definition xlog.c:441
slock_t insertpos_lck
Definition xlog.c:401
uint64 CurrBytePos
Definition xlog.c:410
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:434
XLogRecPtr lastBackupStart
Definition xlog.c:442
XLogRecPtr xlp_pageaddr
XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:206
XLogRecPtr ReadRecPtr
Definition xlogreader.h:205
XLogRecPtr xl_prev
Definition xlogrecord.h:45
pg_crc32c xl_crc
Definition xlogrecord.h:49
uint8 xl_info
Definition xlogrecord.h:46
uint32 xl_tot_len
Definition xlogrecord.h:43
TransactionId xl_xid
Definition xlogrecord.h:44
RmgrId xl_rmid
Definition xlogrecord.h:47
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:331
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:330
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition xlog.c:325
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition xlog.c:324
Definition guc.h:174
TimestampTz rp_time
void StartupSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestActiveXID)
Definition subtrans.c:283
void CheckPointSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:329
void BootStrapSUBTRANS(void)
Definition subtrans.c:269
void TruncateSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestXact)
Definition subtrans.c:385
void ProcessSyncRequests(void)
Definition sync.c:286
void SyncPreCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:177
void SyncPostCheckpoint(void)
Definition sync.c:202
TimeoutId RegisterTimeout(TimeoutId id, timeout_handler_proc handler)
Definition timeout.c:505
@ STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT
Definition timeout.h:38
#define TransactionIdRetreat(dest)
Definition transam.h:141
#define InvalidTransactionId
Definition transam.h:31
static void FullTransactionIdRetreat(FullTransactionId *dest)
Definition transam.h:103
#define XidFromFullTransactionId(x)
Definition transam.h:48
#define FirstGenbkiObjectId
Definition transam.h:195
#define FirstNormalTransactionId
Definition transam.h:34
#define TransactionIdIsValid(xid)
Definition transam.h:41
static FullTransactionId FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(uint32 epoch, TransactionId xid)
Definition transam.h:71
#define TransactionIdIsNormal(xid)
Definition transam.h:42
#define FullTransactionIdPrecedes(a, b)
Definition transam.h:51
static bool TransactionIdPrecedes(TransactionId id1, TransactionId id2)
Definition transam.h:263
void RecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2083
void restoreTwoPhaseData(void)
Definition twophase.c:1904
int max_prepared_xacts
Definition twophase.c:116
TransactionId PrescanPreparedTransactions(TransactionId **xids_p, int *nxids_p)
Definition twophase.c:1966
void StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition twophase.c:2045
void CheckPointTwoPhase(XLogRecPtr redo_horizon)
Definition twophase.c:1822
WALInsertLock l
Definition xlog.c:386
char pad[PG_CACHE_LINE_SIZE]
Definition xlog.c:387
bool SplitIdentifierString(char *rawstring, char separator, List **namelist)
Definition varlena.c:2730
void SetTransactionIdLimit(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition varsup.c:372
void AdvanceOldestClogXid(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid)
Definition varsup.c:355
TransamVariablesData * TransamVariables
Definition varsup.c:34
static void pgstat_report_wait_start(uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition wait_event.h:69
static void pgstat_report_wait_end(void)
Definition wait_event.h:85
#define WL_TIMEOUT
#define WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH
#define WL_LATCH_SET
static TimestampTz wakeup[NUM_WALRCV_WAKEUPS]
XLogRecPtr Flush
XLogRecPtr Write
XLogRecPtr GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(XLogRecPtr *latestChunkStart, TimeLineID *receiveTLI)
void ShutdownWalRcv(void)
void WalSndWakeup(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.c:3810
int max_wal_senders
Definition walsender.c:129
void WalSndInitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:3889
void WalSndWaitStopping(void)
Definition walsender.c:3915
static void WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition walsender.h:65
#define WalSndWakeupRequest()
Definition walsender.h:58
bool summarize_wal
void WaitForWalSummarization(XLogRecPtr lsn)
void WakeupWalSummarizer(void)
XLogRecPtr GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(TimeLineID *tli, bool *lsn_is_exact)
int WalWriterFlushAfter
Definition walwriter.c:71
int WalWriterDelay
Definition walwriter.c:70
#define stat
Definition win32_port.h:74
#define EINTR
Definition win32_port.h:361
#define S_ISDIR(m)
Definition win32_port.h:315
#define kill(pid, sig)
Definition win32_port.h:490
#define SIGUSR1
Definition win32_port.h:170
#define readlink(path, buf, size)
Definition win32_port.h:226
#define O_CLOEXEC
Definition win32_port.h:344
#define O_DSYNC
Definition win32_port.h:346
int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tp, void *tzp)
void MarkSubxactTopXidLogged(void)
Definition xact.c:592
void MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny(void)
Definition xact.c:542
int XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
Definition xlog.c:3417
void assign_wal_sync_method(int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:8816
static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
Definition xlog.c:7506
uint64 GetSystemIdentifier(void)
Definition xlog.c:4627
int wal_decode_buffer_size
Definition xlog.c:139
XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:256
static XLogCtlData * XLogCtl
Definition xlog.c:568
bool fullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:125
void UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
Definition xlog.c:8301
bool RecoveryInProgress(void)
Definition xlog.c:6460
static void CleanupBackupHistory(void)
Definition xlog.c:4198
void GetFullPageWriteInfo(XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
Definition xlog.c:6593
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
Definition xlog.c:6646
XLogRecPtr RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
Definition xlog.c:8195
void do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:9557
XLogSegNo XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
Definition xlog.c:3795
XLogRecPtr XLogInsertRecord(XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn, uint8 flags, int num_fpi, uint64 fpi_bytes, bool topxid_included)
Definition xlog.c:749
char * XLogArchiveCommand
Definition xlog.c:123
int wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:119
Size WALReadFromBuffers(char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1754
static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
Definition xlog.c:1510
static void WALInsertLockRelease(void)
Definition xlog.c:1451
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1864
bool EnableHotStandby
Definition xlog.c:124
static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
Definition xlog.c:1477
XLogRecPtr GetRedoRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6563
void assign_wal_consistency_checking(const char *newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:4831
static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:4241
void SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9646
static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
Definition xlog.c:1991
static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
Definition xlog.c:1422
static void UpdateControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4618
void StartupXLOG(void)
Definition xlog.c:5517
bool IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9663
static int openLogFile
Definition xlog.c:637
void BootStrapXLOG(uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition xlog.c:5126
XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd
Definition xlog.c:257
bool CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7721
static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
Definition xlog.c:4136
int CommitDelay
Definition xlog.c:135
static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3902
static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:7571
XLogRecPtr GetInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6608
bool wal_init_zero
Definition xlog.c:130
static void CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
Definition xlog.c:2174
XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
Definition xlog.c:2682
int XLogArchiveMode
Definition xlog.c:122
SessionBackupState get_backup_status(void)
Definition xlog.c:9264
static void XLogReportParameters(void)
Definition xlog.c:8238
#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target)
Definition xlog.c:622
void CheckXLogRemoved(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3764
int wal_level
Definition xlog.c:134
static void LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
Definition xlog.c:6775
static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition xlog.c:276
void assign_checkpoint_completion_target(double newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2210
static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3600
static void WriteControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4276
int wal_segment_size
Definition xlog.c:146
WALAvailability GetWALAvailability(XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
Definition xlog.c:8002
const char * show_archive_command(void)
Definition xlog.c:4884
#define UsableBytesInPage
Definition xlog.c:599
int max_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:117
void XLOGShmemInit(void)
Definition xlog.c:5011
void ShutdownXLOG(int code, Datum arg)
Definition xlog.c:6728
bool DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
Definition xlog.c:4647
static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
Definition xlog.c:6410
RecoveryState GetRecoveryState(void)
Definition xlog.c:6496
int XLogArchiveTimeout
Definition xlog.c:121
static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5377
#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)
Definition xlog.c:605
bool wal_recycle
Definition xlog.c:131
static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:4046
pg_time_t GetLastSegSwitchData(XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
Definition xlog.c:6711
const char * show_effective_wal_level(void)
Definition xlog.c:4911
static int XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
Definition xlog.c:4693
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition xlog.c:1904
static int get_sync_bit(int method)
Definition xlog.c:8768
static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult
Definition xlog.c:614
void XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(XLogRecPtr lsn)
Definition xlog.c:2669
static void LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint)
Definition xlog.c:6807
void SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6335
static bool lastFullPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:220
char * wal_consistency_checking_string
Definition xlog.c:128
static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
Definition xlog.c:1377
int CommitSiblings
Definition xlog.c:136
static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1231
bool GetDefaultCharSignedness(void)
Definition xlog.c:4661
static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate
Definition xlog.c:162
static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
Definition xlog.c:1947
const char * show_in_hot_standby(void)
Definition xlog.c:4896
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:9598
Size XLOGShmemSize(void)
Definition xlog.c:4961
void SetWalWriterSleeping(bool sleeping)
Definition xlog.c:9678
bool wal_log_hints
Definition xlog.c:126
static void XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:5302
static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
Definition xlog.c:5473
#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)
Definition xlog.c:593
int wal_sync_method
Definition xlog.c:133
int XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3655
int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:138
XLogRecPtr GetFlushRecPtr(TimeLineID *insertTLI)
Definition xlog.c:6625
static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3727
static bool doPageWrites
Definition xlog.c:289
static bool holdingAllLocks
Definition xlog.c:654
static TimeLineID openLogTLI
Definition xlog.c:639
XLogRecPtr XactLastCommitEnd
Definition xlog.c:258
WalLevel GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby(void)
Definition xlog.c:4952
bool log_checkpoints
Definition xlog.c:132
static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
Definition xlog.c:8086
static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
Definition xlog.c:2307
void InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(void)
Definition xlog.c:4858
static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
Definition xlog.c:2703
static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6548
void assign_max_wal_size(int newval, void *extra)
Definition xlog.c:2203
void RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition xlog.c:3977
XLogRecPtr GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:6682
void xlog_redo(XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:8370
static int MyLockNo
Definition xlog.c:653
static void RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
Definition xlog.c:7681
bool XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:3145
void register_persistent_abort_backup_handler(void)
Definition xlog.c:9584
static double PrevCheckPointDistance
Definition xlog.c:163
void ReachedEndOfBackup(XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:6373
void LocalProcessControlFile(bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:4939
static void XLogFileClose(void)
Definition xlog.c:3676
int wal_compression
Definition xlog.c:127
static void UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
Definition xlog.c:6912
static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress
Definition xlog.c:227
XLogSegNo XLogGetOldestSegno(TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:3811
XLogRecPtr GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
Definition xlog.c:9614
void ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition xlog.c:9655
static WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition xlog.c:571
static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo
Definition xlog.c:638
#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)
Definition xlog.c:582
int wal_retrieve_retry_interval
Definition xlog.c:137
int XLOGbuffers
Definition xlog.c:120
bool XLogBackgroundFlush(void)
Definition xlog.c:2988
const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[]
Definition xlog.c:194
void GetOldestRestartPoint(XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
Definition xlog.c:9626
char * GetMockAuthenticationNonce(void)
Definition xlog.c:4637
bool track_wal_io_timing
Definition xlog.c:140
static XLogSegNo XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
Definition xlog.c:2233
static int UsableBytesInSegment
Definition xlog.c:608
static char * GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:1638
WalInsertClass
Definition xlog.c:562
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH
Definition xlog.c:564
@ WALINSERT_NORMAL
Definition xlog.c:563
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
Definition xlog.c:565
bool XLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition xlog.c:6515
void do_pg_backup_start(const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces, BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
Definition xlog.c:8955
static ControlFileData * ControlFile
Definition xlog.c:576
bool check_wal_segment_size(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:2217
static void XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno, int upto)
Definition xlog.c:3455
static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed
Definition xlog.c:239
static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
Definition xlog.c:3869
XLogRecPtr XLogRestorePoint(const char *rpName)
Definition xlog.c:8213
static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:648
#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS
Definition xlog.c:153
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet(void)
Definition xlog.c:6662
void do_pg_backup_stop(BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
Definition xlog.c:9283
bool check_wal_consistency_checking(char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:4744
const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[]
Definition xlog.c:174
int min_wal_size_mb
Definition xlog.c:118
bool CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7015
#define BootstrapTimeLineID
Definition xlog.c:114
CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats
Definition xlog.c:212
bool check_wal_buffers(int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
Definition xlog.c:4709
XLogRecPtr GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel(void)
Definition xlog.c:4676
static char * str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
Definition xlog.c:5289
void XLogPutNextOid(Oid nextOid)
Definition xlog.c:8158
void XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition xlog.c:2783
static void ReadControlFile(void)
Definition xlog.c:4386
static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState
Definition xlog.c:394
static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
Definition xlog.c:7641
static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint
Definition xlog.c:650
int CheckPointSegments
Definition xlog.c:159
static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred
Definition xlog.c:169
static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1114
void XLogShutdownWalRcv(void)
Definition xlog.c:9636
#define NextBufIdx(idx)
Definition xlog.c:586
static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
Definition xlog.c:3849
static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI
Definition xlog.c:649
void issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition xlog.c:8858
static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition xlog.c:1170
void XLogSetAsyncXactLSN(XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
Definition xlog.c:2612
bool XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
Definition xlog.c:2283
bool * wal_consistency_checking
Definition xlog.c:129
static int XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli, bool *added, char *path)
Definition xlog.c:3229
static void update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
Definition xlog.c:6950
#define XLogArchivingActive()
Definition xlog.h:101
#define TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD
Definition xlog.h:323
#define XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT
Definition xlog.h:166
#define TABLESPACE_MAP
Definition xlog.h:322
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS
Definition xlog.h:68
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF
Definition xlog.h:66
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ON
Definition xlog.h:67
#define CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED
Definition xlog.h:154
#define XLogLogicalInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:136
#define STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:318
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG
Definition xlog.h:159
WALAvailability
Definition xlog.h:199
@ WALAVAIL_REMOVED
Definition xlog.h:205
@ WALAVAIL_RESERVED
Definition xlog.h:201
@ WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED
Definition xlog.h:204
@ WALAVAIL_EXTENDED
Definition xlog.h:202
@ WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN
Definition xlog.h:200
#define BACKUP_LABEL_OLD
Definition xlog.h:320
#define CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition xlog.h:151
@ WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE
Definition xlog.h:83
#define BACKUP_LABEL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:319
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME
Definition xlog.h:160
#define CHECKPOINT_FORCE
Definition xlog.h:153
SessionBackupState
Definition xlog.h:303
@ SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING
Definition xlog.h:305
@ SESSION_BACKUP_NONE
Definition xlog.h:304
#define CHECKPOINT_WAIT
Definition xlog.h:156
#define CHECKPOINT_FAST
Definition xlog.h:152
#define RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition xlog.h:317
#define CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN
Definition xlog.h:150
#define XLogArchivingAlways()
Definition xlog.h:104
WalLevel
Definition xlog.h:74
@ WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA
Definition xlog.h:76
@ WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL
Definition xlog.h:77
@ WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL
Definition xlog.h:75
RecoveryState
Definition xlog.h:91
@ RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH
Definition xlog.h:92
@ RECOVERY_STATE_DONE
Definition xlog.h:94
@ RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE
Definition xlog.h:93
#define XLogIsNeeded()
Definition xlog.h:111
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN
Definition xlog.h:27
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC
Definition xlog.h:26
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
Definition xlog.h:28
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC
Definition xlog.h:29
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC
Definition xlog.h:25
#define XLogStandbyInfoActive()
Definition xlog.h:125
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD
static RmgrData GetRmgr(RmgrId rmid)
#define IsValidWalSegSize(size)
XLogLongPageHeaderData * XLogLongPageHeader
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
#define XLOG_CONTROL_FILE
#define XLogSegmentOffset(xlogptr, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsXLogFileName(const char *fname)
static void XLogFromFileName(const char *fname, TimeLineID *tli, XLogSegNo *logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLByteToPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(segno, offset, wal_segsz_bytes, dest)
#define MAXFNAMELEN
XLogPageHeaderData * XLogPageHeader
#define XLOGDIR
#define XLP_LONG_HEADER
static bool IsBackupHistoryFileName(const char *fname)
#define XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE
#define XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC
#define XLByteToSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void XLogFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XRecOffIsValid(xlrp)
#define SizeOfXLogShortPHD
#define SizeOfXLogLongPHD
static void XLogFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool RmgrIdExists(RmgrId rmid)
#define XLByteInPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static bool IsPartialXLogFileName(const char *fname)
bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsBusy(const char *xlog)
bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotifySeg(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
void ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, uint32 wait_event_info)
bool XLogArchiveCheckDone(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveNotify(const char *xlog)
void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog)
char * build_backup_content(BackupState *state, bool ishistoryfile)
Definition xlogbackup.c:29
#define XLogRecPtrIsValid(r)
Definition xlogdefs.h:29
#define LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn)
Definition xlogdefs.h:47
#define FirstNormalUnloggedLSN
Definition xlogdefs.h:37
uint64 XLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:21
#define InvalidXLogRecPtr
Definition xlogdefs.h:28
uint32 TimeLineID
Definition xlogdefs.h:63
#define DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD
Definition xlogdefs.h:83
uint64 XLogSegNo
Definition xlogdefs.h:52
XLogRecPtr XLogInsert(RmgrId rmid, uint8 info)
Definition xloginsert.c:478
void XLogRegisterData(const void *data, uint32 len)
Definition xloginsert.c:368
void XLogSetRecordFlags(uint8 flags)
Definition xloginsert.c:460
void XLogBeginInsert(void)
Definition xloginsert.c:152
XLogReaderState * XLogReaderAllocate(int wal_segment_size, const char *waldir, XLogReaderRoutine *routine, void *private_data)
Definition xlogreader.c:107
bool DecodeXLogRecord(XLogReaderState *state, DecodedXLogRecord *decoded, XLogRecord *record, XLogRecPtr lsn, char **errormsg)
size_t DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(size_t xl_tot_len)
#define XLogRecGetInfo(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:409
#define XLogRecGetData(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:414
#define XL_ROUTINE(...)
Definition xlogreader.h:117
#define XLogRecMaxBlockId(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:417
#define XLogRecHasBlockImage(decoder, block_id)
Definition xlogreader.h:422
#define XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(decoder)
Definition xlogreader.h:416
#define SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort
Definition xlogrecord.h:217
#define XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT
Definition xlogrecord.h:241
#define SizeOfXLogRecord
Definition xlogrecord.h:55
void ShutdownWalRecovery(void)
bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested
bool InArchiveRecovery
void RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(const char *param_name, int currValue, int minValue)
void PerformWalRecovery(void)
char * archiveCleanupCommand
XLogRecPtr GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayEndTLI)
void xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record)
bool PromoteIsTriggered(void)
static XLogRecPtr missingContrecPtr
XLogRecPtr GetXLogReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayTLI)
static XLogRecPtr abortedRecPtr
EndOfWalRecoveryInfo * FinishWalRecovery(void)
void InitWalRecovery(ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool *wasShutdown_ptr, bool *haveBackupLabel_ptr, bool *haveTblspcMap_ptr)
char * recoveryEndCommand
TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLI
TimestampTz GetLatestXTime(void)
bool XLogHaveInvalidPages(void)
Definition xlogutils.c:224
XLogRedoAction XLogReadBufferForRedo(XLogReaderState *record, uint8 block_id, Buffer *buf)
Definition xlogutils.c:303
HotStandbyState standbyState
Definition xlogutils.c:53
bool InRecovery
Definition xlogutils.c:50
@ STANDBY_DISABLED
Definition xlogutils.h:52
@ STANDBY_INITIALIZED
Definition xlogutils.h:53
#define InHotStandby
Definition xlogutils.h:60
@ BLK_RESTORED
Definition xlogutils.h:76
struct WaitLSNState * waitLSNState
Definition xlogwait.c:68
void WaitLSNWakeup(WaitLSNType lsnType, XLogRecPtr currentLSN)
Definition xlogwait.c:317
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_PRIMARY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:44
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_REPLAY
Definition xlogwait.h:39
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_FLUSH
Definition xlogwait.h:41
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_STANDBY_WRITE
Definition xlogwait.h:40